flash/nor/stm32f1x: use address instead of offset in stm32x_write_block()
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1810 following example.
1811 @end itemize
1812
1813 @example
1814 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1816 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1819 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1820 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1821 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1822 > resume
1823 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1824 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1825 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1826 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1827 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1828 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1829 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1830 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1831 @end example
1832
1833
1834 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1835
1836 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1837 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1838 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1839
1840 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1841 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1842 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1843 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1844 both signals.
1845
1846 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1847 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1848 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1849 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1850 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1851 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1852 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1853 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1854 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1855 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1856 not available.)
1857
1858 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1859 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1860 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1861 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1862 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1863 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1864 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1865 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1866
1867 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1868 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1869 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1870 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1871 slower clock than they will use later.
1872 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1873 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1874 than they will use later.
1875 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1876
1877 @quotation Important
1878 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1879 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1880 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1881 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1882 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1883 @end quotation
1884
1885 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1886 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1887 @cindex init_targets procedure
1888
1889 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1890 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1891 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1892 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1893 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1894 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1895 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1896 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1897 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1898
1899 @example
1900 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1901
1902 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1903 # basic initialization procedure ...
1904 @}
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1909 @}
1910
1911 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1912
1913 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1914
1915 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1916 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1917 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1918 @}
1919 @end example
1920
1921 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1922 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1923
1924 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1925
1926 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1928
1929 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1930 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1931 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1932
1933 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1934 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1935 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1936 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1937 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1938 events already assigned.
1939
1940 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1941
1942 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1943 special high speed download features - enable it.
1944
1945 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1946
1947 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1948 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1949 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1950 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1951 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1952 If you are using an external trace port,
1953 configure it in your board config file.
1954 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1955 configure it in your target config file.
1956
1957 @example
1958 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1959 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1960 @end example
1961
1962 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1963
1964 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1965
1966 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1967 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1968 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1969 the TARGET (chip) file.
1970
1971 Examples:
1972 @itemize @bullet
1973 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1974 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1975 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1976 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1977 @end itemize
1978
1979 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1980 @section Translating Configuration Files
1981 @cindex translation
1982 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1983 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1984 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1985 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1986 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1987 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1988
1989 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1990 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1991 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1992 convert other scripts later on.
1993
1994 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1995 replace job:
1996
1997 @example
1998 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1999 #
2000 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2001 #
2002 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2003 #
2004 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2005
2006 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2007 global TARGETNAME
2008
2009 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2010
2011 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2012 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2014 @}
2015 @end example
2016
2017
2018
2019 @node Server Configuration
2020 @chapter Server Configuration
2021 @cindex initialization
2022 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2023 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2024 supported.
2025
2026 @anchor{configurationstage}
2027 @section Configuration Stage
2028 @cindex configuration stage
2029 @cindex config command
2030
2031 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2032 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2033 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2034 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2035 inside startup scripts.
2036
2037 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2038 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2039 which may be issued interactively.
2040 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2041 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2042
2043 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2044 flash banks,
2045 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2046 and other basic setup.
2047 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2048 may access or activate TAPs.
2049 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2050 longer be issued.
2051
2052 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2053 @section Entering the Run Stage
2054
2055 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2056 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2057 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2058 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2059 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2060 You should see no errors at this point.
2061 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2062 commands you used to configure the server.
2063 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2064 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2065 on the scan chain.
2066
2067 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2068 become available.
2069 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2070 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2071 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2072 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2073 entry to the run stage.
2074
2075 @deffn {Config Command} init
2076 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2077 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2078 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2079 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2080 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2081 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2082
2083 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2084 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2085 configuration files and/or command line options.
2086
2087 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2088 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2089 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2090 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2091 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2092 @end deffn
2093
2094 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2095 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2096 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2097
2098 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2099 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2100 scan chain.
2101 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2102 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2103
2104 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2105 they return.
2106 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2107 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2108 @end deffn
2109
2110 @anchor{tcpipports}
2111 @section TCP/IP Ports
2112 @cindex TCP port
2113 @cindex server
2114 @cindex port
2115 @cindex security
2116 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2117 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2118 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2119
2120 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2121 access using one or more of these ports.
2122 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2123 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2124 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2125
2126 @anchor{gdb_port}
2127 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2128 @cindex GDB server
2129 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2130 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2131 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2132 the normal use cases.
2133
2134 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2135 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2136 disables the gdb server.
2137
2138 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2139 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2140
2141 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2142 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2143
2144 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2145 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2146 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2147
2148 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2149 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2152 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2153 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2154 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2155 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2156 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2157
2158 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2159 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2160 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2161 @end deffn
2162
2163 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2164 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2165 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2166 output from the Tcl engine.
2167 Intended as a machine interface.
2168 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2169 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2170 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2174 Specify or query the
2175 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2176 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2177 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2178 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2179 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2180 @end deffn
2181
2182 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2183 @section GDB Configuration
2184 @cindex GDB
2185 @cindex GDB configuration
2186 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2187 The ones listed here are static and global.
2188 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2189 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2190
2191 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2192 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2193 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2194 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2195 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2196 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2197 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2198 @end deffn
2199
2200 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2201 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2202 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2203 vFlash packet is received.
2204 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2209 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2210 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2211 for flash programming to work.
2212 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2213 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2214 @end deffn
2215
2216 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2217 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2218 by GDB memory read packets.
2219 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2220 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2224 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2225 packets report errors or not.
2226 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2227 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2232 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2236 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2237
2238 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2239 @end deffn
2240
2241 @anchor{eventpolling}
2242 @section Event Polling
2243
2244 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2245 where significant events can happen at any time.
2246 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2247 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2248 or to GDB.
2249
2250 Examples of such events include:
2251
2252 @itemize
2253 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2254 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2255 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2256 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2257 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2258 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2259 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2260 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2261 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2262 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2263 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2264 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2265 @end itemize
2266
2267 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2268 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2269 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2270 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2271 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2272
2273 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2274 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2275 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2276 to the various active targets.
2277 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2278 which is normally done in the background.
2279
2280 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2281 Poll the current target for its current state.
2282 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2283 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2284 specific information about the current state is printed.
2285 An optional parameter
2286 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2287
2288 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2289 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2290 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2291 @example
2292 > poll
2293 background polling: on
2294 target state: halted
2295 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2296 current mode: Supervisor
2297 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2298 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2299 >
2300 @end example
2301 @end deffn
2302
2303 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2304 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @cindex config file, interface
2306 @cindex interface config file
2307
2308 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2309 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2310 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2311
2312 @quotation Note
2313 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2314 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2315 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2316 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2317 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2318 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2319 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2320 @end quotation
2321
2322 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2323 through commands in an interface configuration
2324 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2325 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2326
2327 @example
2328 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2329 @end example
2330
2331 These commands tell
2332 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2333 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2334
2335 @example
2336 # jlink interface
2337 interface jlink
2338 @end example
2339
2340 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2341
2342
2343 @section Interface Configuration
2344
2345 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2346 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2347 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2350 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2351 target.
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2355 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2356 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2357 @end deffn
2358 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2359 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2360 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2361 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2362 the hardware can support.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365
2366
2367 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2368 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @section Interface Drivers
2372
2373 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2374 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2375 available at run time.
2376
2377 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2378 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2379 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2380 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2381
2382 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2383 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2384 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2385 @end deffn
2386
2387 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2388 Displays status of RTCK option.
2389 Optionally sets that option first.
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2394 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2395 This has one driver-specific command:
2396
2397 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2398 Logs some status
2399 @end deffn
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2403 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2404 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2405 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2406 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2407 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2408 @end deffn
2409
2410 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2411 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2414 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2415 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2416 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2417 @example
2418 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2419 @end example
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2423 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2424 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2428 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2429 @end deffn
2430 @end deffn
2431
2432 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2433 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2434 @end deffn
2435
2436 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2437 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2438 @end deffn
2439
2440 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2441 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2442 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2443
2444 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2445 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2446
2447 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2448 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2449
2450 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2451 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2452 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2453 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2454 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2455 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2456
2457 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2458 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2459 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2460 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2461 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2462
2463 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2464 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2465 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2466 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2467
2468 @itemize @minus
2469 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2470 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2471 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2472 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2473 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2474 switching data and direction as necessary
2475 @end itemize
2476
2477 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2478 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2481 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2482 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2483 @example
2484 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2485 @end example
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2489 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2490 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2491 during device selection.
2492 @end deffn
2493
2494 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2495 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2496 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2497 is connected to the host.
2498 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2499 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2500 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2504 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2505 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2506 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2507 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2508 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2509
2510 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2514 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2515 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2519 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2520 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2521 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2522 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2523 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2524 and initially asserted reset signals.
2525 @end deffn
2526
2527 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2528 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2529 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2530 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2531 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2532 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2533 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2534 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2535 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2536 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2537 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2538
2539 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2540 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2541 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2542 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2543 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2544 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2545
2546 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2547 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2548 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2549 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2550 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2551 are always driven by the FTDI.
2552
2553 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2554 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2555 @var{name}.
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2559 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2560 @itemize @minus
2561 @item @option{0}, drive low
2562 @item @option{1}, drive high
2563 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2564 @end itemize
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2568 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2572 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2573
2574 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2575 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2576 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2577 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2578 @itemize @minus
2579 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2580 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2581 @end itemize
2582 @end deffn
2583
2584 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2585 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2586
2587 @end deffn
2588
2589 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2590 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2591 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2592 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2593
2594 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2595 @itemize @minus
2596 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2597 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2598 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2599 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2600 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2601 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2602 @end itemize
2603
2604 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2605 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2606 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2607 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2608 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2609 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2610 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2611 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2612
2613 FT232R
2614 @itemize @minus
2615 @item bit 7 - RI
2616 @item bit 6 - DCD
2617 @item bit 5 - DSR
2618 @item bit 4 - DTR
2619 @item bit 3 - CTS
2620 @item bit 2 - RTS
2621 @item bit 1 - RXD
2622 @item bit 0 - TXD
2623 @end itemize
2624
2625 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2626 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2627
2628 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2629 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2630 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2634 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2635 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2636 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2637 @end deffn
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2640 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2641 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2645 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2649 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2653 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2654 @end deffn
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2657 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2658 @end deffn
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2661 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2665 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2666 @end deffn
2667
2668 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2669 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2670 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2671 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2672 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2673 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2674 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2675 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2676 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2677 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2678 @end deffn
2679
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2683 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2684 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2685 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2686
2687 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2688 processors which are being simulated.
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2691 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2692 sockets instead of TCP.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2696 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2697 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2701 something like:
2702
2703 @example
2704 interface remote_bitbang
2705 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2706 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2707 @end example
2708
2709 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2710 named mysocket:
2711
2712 @example
2713 interface remote_bitbang
2714 remote_bitbang_port 0
2715 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2716 @end example
2717 @end deffn
2718
2719 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2720 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2721 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2722 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2723
2724 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2725 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2726 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2727 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2728 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2732 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2733 default values are used.
2734 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2735 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2736 @example
2737 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2738 @end example
2739 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2740 @example
2741 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2742 @end example
2743 @end deffn
2744
2745 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2746 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2747 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2748 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2749 target board.
2750
2751 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2752 @example
2753 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2754 reset_config srst_only
2755 @end example
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2759 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2760 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2761 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2765 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2766 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @end deffn
2770
2771 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2772 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2773 This has one driver-specific command:
2774
2775 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2776 Display either the address of the I/O port
2777 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2778 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2779 This is a write-once setting.
2780 @end deffn
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2784 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2785 transports.
2786
2787 @quotation Compatibility Note
2788 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2789 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2790 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2791 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2792 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2793 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2794 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2795 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2796 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2797 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2798 @end quotation
2799
2800 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2801 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2802 states.
2803 @end deffn
2804 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2805 Display free device internal memory.
2806 @end deffn
2807 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2808 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2809 command version.
2810 @end deffn
2811 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2812 Display the device configuration.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2815 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2816 power state.
2817 @end deffn
2818 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2819 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2822 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2823 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2824 IP configuration.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2827 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2828 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2831 Reset the current configuration.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2834 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2837 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2838 pairs.
2839
2840 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2841 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2842 @example
2843 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2844 @end example
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2847 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2851 @example
2852 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2853 77a90000
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2857 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2858 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2859 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2860 instead.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2865 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2866 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2867
2868 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @end deffn
2871
2872 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2873 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2874 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2875 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2876 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2877 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2878 configuration script.
2879
2880 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2881 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2882 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2883 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2884 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2885
2886 Known limitations:
2887 @itemize @bullet
2888 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2889 and 2.7 MHz.
2890 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2891 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2892 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2893 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2894 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2895 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2896 communications with the target.
2897 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2898 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2899 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2900 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2901 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2902 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2903 @end itemize
2904
2905 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2906 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2907 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2911 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2912 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2916 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2917 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2918 target as a side-effect.
2919 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2923 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2924 version, and target voltage.
2925 @end deffn
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2929 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2930 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2931 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2932 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2933
2934 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2935 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2936 This is a write-once setting.
2937 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2938
2939 @itemize @minus
2940 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2941 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2942 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2943 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2944 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2945 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2946 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2947 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2948 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2949 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2950 some versions of
2951 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2952 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2953 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2954 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2955 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2956 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2957 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2958 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2959 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2960 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2961 @end itemize
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2965 Display either the address of the I/O port
2966 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2967 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2968 This is a write-once setting.
2969
2970 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2971 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2972 you may encounter a problem.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2976 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2977 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2978 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2979 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2980 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2981
2982 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2983 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2984 @quotation Tip
2985 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2986 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2987 @example
2988 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2989 > adapter_khz 500
2990 @end example
2991 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2992 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2993 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2994 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2995 large set of samples.
2996 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2997 @example
2998 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2999 @end example
3000 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3001 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3002
3003 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3004 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3005 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3006 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3007 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3008 @end quotation
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3012 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3013 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3017 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3018
3019 @example
3020 interface parport
3021 parport_port 0x278
3022 parport_cable wiggler
3023 @end example
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3027 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3028 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3029 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3030 @end deffn
3031 @end deffn
3032
3033 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3034 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3038 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3042 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3043
3044 @quotation Note
3045 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3046 which are not currently documented here.
3047 @end quotation
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @anchor{hla_interface}
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3052 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3053 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3054 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3055
3056 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3057 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3058 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3059 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3060 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3061
3062 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3063 Currently Not Supported.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3067 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3068 @end deffn
3069
3070 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3071 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3075 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3079 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3080 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3081 @end deffn
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3085 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3089 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3090 @end deffn
3091
3092 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3093 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @quotation Note
3097 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3098 which are not currently documented here.
3099 @end quotation
3100
3101 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3102 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3103 No arguments: print status.
3104 @end deffn
3105
3106 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3107 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3108 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3109
3110 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3111 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3112 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3113 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3114 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3115 configuration on exit.
3116
3117 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3118 pinout.
3119
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3123 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3124 of the one which is most popular.
3125
3126 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3127
3128 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3129 pinout.
3130
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3135 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3136 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3137
3138 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3139 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3140 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3141
3142 @itemize @minus
3143 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3144 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3145 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3146 @end itemize
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3150 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3151 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3152 @end deffn
3153 @end deffn
3154
3155 @section Transport Configuration
3156 @cindex Transport
3157 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3158 and the debug adapter you are using,
3159 several transports may be available to
3160 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3161 @deffn Command {transport list}
3162 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3163 version of OpenOCD.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3167 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3168
3169 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3170 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3171 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3172 adapter's driver).
3173
3174 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3175 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3176 supported by the debug adapter.
3177
3178 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3179 transport, if any.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @subsection JTAG Transport
3183 @cindex JTAG
3184 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3185 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3186 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3187 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3188 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3189 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3190
3191 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3192 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3193 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3194 hla_jtag}.
3195
3196 @subsection SWD Transport
3197 @cindex SWD
3198 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3199 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3200 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3201 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3202 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3203 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3204 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3205
3206 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3207 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3208 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3209 hla_swd}.
3210
3211 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3212 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3213 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3214 expected to change.
3215 @end deffn
3216 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3217 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3218 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3219 No parameters: displays current settings.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @subsection SPI Transport
3223 @cindex SPI
3224 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3225 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3226 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3227 solution for flash programming.
3228
3229 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3230 @section JTAG Speed
3231 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3232 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3233 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3234 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3235 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3236 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3237 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3238 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3239 power management software that may be active.
3240
3241 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3242 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3243 target event handler.
3244 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3245 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3246 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3247 sets up those clocks).
3248 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3249 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3250 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3251 in the target config file.
3252 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3253 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3254 config file instead.
3255 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3256 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3257 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3258
3259 @example
3260 jtag_rclk 3000
3261 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3262 @end example
3263
3264 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3265 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3266 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3267 may not be the fastest solution.
3268
3269 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3270 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3271 which support adaptive clocking.
3272
3273 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3274 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3275 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3276 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3277 than the speed specified.
3278
3279 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3280 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3281 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3282 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3283
3284 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3285 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3286 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3287 JTAG clocking after setup.
3288 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3289 If the interface device can not
3290 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3291 @end deffn
3292
3293 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3294 @cindex adaptive clocking
3295 @cindex RTCK
3296 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3297 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3298 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3299 @example
3300 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3301 jtag_rclk 3000
3302 @end example
3303 @end defun
3304
3305 @node Reset Configuration
3306 @chapter Reset Configuration
3307 @cindex Reset Configuration
3308
3309 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3310 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3311 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3312 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3313 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3314 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3315 Please see the various board files for examples.
3316
3317 @quotation Note
3318 To maintainers and integrators:
3319 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3320 Normally the board configuration file
3321 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3322 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3323
3324 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3325 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3326 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3327 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3328 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3329 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3330 @end quotation
3331
3332 @section Types of Reset
3333
3334 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3335 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3336 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3337
3338 @itemize @bullet
3339 @item
3340 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3341 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3342 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3343 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3344 @item
3345 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3346 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3347 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3348 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3349 @item
3350 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3351 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3352 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3353 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3354 @item
3355 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3356 several other types of reset.
3357 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3358 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3359 There may be individual module resets.
3360 @end itemize
3361
3362 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3363 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3364 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3365 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3366 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3367 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3368 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3369 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3370 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3371
3372 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3373 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3374
3375 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3376 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3377 common issues are:
3378
3379 @itemize @bullet
3380
3381 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3382 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3383 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3384 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3385 when either of those signals is not connected.
3386 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3387 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3388 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3389 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3390
3391 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3392 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3393 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3394 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3395
3396 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3397 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3398 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3399 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3400 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3401 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3402 hardware debouncing.
3403 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3404 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3407 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3408 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3409 to use push/pull output drivers.
3410 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3411 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3412 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3413 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3414
3415 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3416 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3417 issues (not limited to errata).
3418 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3419 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3420 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3421 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3422 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3423 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3424 @end itemize
3425
3426 There can also be other issues.
3427 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3428 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3429 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3430 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3431 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3432 Agreement (NDA).
3433
3434 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3435 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3436 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3437
3438 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3439 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3440
3441 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3442
3443 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3444 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3445 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3446 allowing it to be deasserted.
3447 @end deffn
3448
3449 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3450 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3451 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3452 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3453 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3457 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3458 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3459 allowing it to be deasserted.
3460 @end deffn
3461
3462 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3463 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3464 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3465 @end deffn
3466
3467 @anchor {reset_config}
3468 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3469 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3470 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3471 configuration scripts.
3472
3473 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3474 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3475 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3476 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3477 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3478 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3479 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3480 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3481
3482 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3483 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3484 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3485 -- may be specified at a time.
3486 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3487 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3488 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3489 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3490 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3491
3492 @itemize
3493 @item
3494 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3495 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3496 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3497 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3498 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3499
3500 @quotation Tip
3501 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3502 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3503 @end quotation
3504
3505 @item
3506 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3507 signal implementations.
3508 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3509 indicating everything behaves normally.
3510 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3511 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3512 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3513 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3514 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3515 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3516 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3517
3518 @item
3519 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3520 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3521 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3522 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3523 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3524 while SRST is asserted.
3525 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3526 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3527
3528 @item
3529 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3530 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3531 is required to use this option.
3532 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3533 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3534 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3535 be asserted before any target connection.
3536 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3537 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3538 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3539 @end itemize
3540
3541 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3542 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3543 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3544 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3545 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3546
3547 @itemize
3548 @item
3549 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3550 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3551 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3552 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3553
3554 @item
3555 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3556 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3557 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3558 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3559 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3560 @end itemize
3561 @end deffn
3562
3563 @section Custom Reset Handling
3564 @cindex events
3565
3566 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3567 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3568 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3569 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3570 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3571 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3572
3573 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3574 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3575 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3576 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3577 want to reset everything at once.
3578
3579 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3580 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3581 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3582 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3583 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3584 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3585 needs special attention.
3586
3587 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3588 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3589 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3590 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3591 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3592 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3593 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3594 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3595
3596 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3597 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3598 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3599 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3600 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3601
3602 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3603 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3604 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3605 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3606 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3607 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3608 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3609 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3610 or potentially some other value.
3611
3612 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3613 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3614 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3615 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3616 (or their associated targets)
3617 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3618
3619 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3620 they return.
3621 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3622 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3623 @end deffn
3624
3625 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3626 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3627 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3628 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3629 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3630 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3631 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3632 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3633 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3634 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3635 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3636 @end deffn
3637
3638 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3639 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3640 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3641 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3642 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3643 @end deffn
3644
3645
3646 @node TAP Declaration
3647 @chapter TAP Declaration
3648 @cindex TAP declaration
3649 @cindex TAP configuration
3650
3651 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3652 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3653
3654 @itemize @bullet
3655 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3656 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3657 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3658 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3659 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3660 start running that code.
3661 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3662 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3663 and missing connections.
3664 @end itemize
3665
3666 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3667 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3668 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3669 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3670 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3671
3672 @section Scan Chains
3673 @cindex scan chain
3674
3675 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3676 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3677 They also need to be added to
3678 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3679 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3680 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3681 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3682 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3683 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3684 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3685 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3686
3687 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3688 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3689 command, presented in the next chapter.
3690 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3691 debugging targets.)
3692 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3693
3694 @verbatim
3695 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3696 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3697 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3698 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3699 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3700 @end verbatim
3701
3702 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3703 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3704 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3705 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3706 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3707 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3708 until they are told to do so.
3709
3710 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3711 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3712 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3713 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3714
3715 @example
3716 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3717 @end example
3718
3719 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3720 by a given chip.
3721 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3722 and so forth.
3723 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3724 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3725 both inside a single chip and between them.
3726 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3727
3728 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3729 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3730 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3731 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3732 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3733 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3734 includes commands something like this:
3735
3736 @example
3737 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3738 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3739 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3740 @end example
3741
3742 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3743 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3744 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3745
3746 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3747 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3748 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3749 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3750 @example
3751 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3752 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3753 @}
3754 @end example
3755 @end deffn
3756
3757 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3758 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3759 and their status.
3760 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3761 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3762 but systems with a JTAG router can
3763 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3764 @end deffn
3765
3766 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3767 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3768
3769 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3770 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3771
3772 @section TAP Names
3773 @cindex dotted name
3774
3775 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3776 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3777 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3778 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3779 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3780 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3781 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3782 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3783
3784 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3785 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3786 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3787
3788 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3789
3790 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3791 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3792 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3793 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3794
3795 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3796 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3797 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3798 overridable.
3799
3800 @cindex TAP naming convention
3801 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3802 and should follow this convention:
3803
3804 @itemize @bullet
3805 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3806 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3807 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3808 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3809 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3810 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3811 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3812 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3813 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3814 with a single TAP;
3815 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3816 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3817 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3818 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3819 @end itemize
3820
3821 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3822
3823 @itemize @bullet
3824 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3825 @*The length in bits of the
3826 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3827 @end itemize
3828
3829 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3830
3831 @itemize @bullet
3832 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3833 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3834 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3835 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3836 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3837 (the TAP is linked in).
3838 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3839 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3840 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3841 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3842 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3843 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3844 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3845 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3846 values that were found but not included in the list.
3847
3848 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3849 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3850 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3851 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3852 hardware to find these values.
3853 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3854 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3855 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3856 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3857 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3858 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3859 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3860 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3861 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3862 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3863 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3864 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3865 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3866 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3867 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3868 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3869 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3870 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3871 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3872 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3873 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3874 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3875 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3876 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3877 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3878 @end itemize
3879 @end deffn
3880
3881 @section Other TAP commands
3882
3883 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3884 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3885 At this writing this TAP attribute
3886 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3887 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3888 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3889 See the next section for information about the available events.
3890
3891 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3892 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3893 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3894 @end deffn
3895
3896 @section TAP Events
3897 @cindex events
3898 @cindex TAP events
3899
3900 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3901 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3902 The other applies to debugger targets,
3903 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3904
3905 The TAP events currently defined are:
3906
3907 @itemize @bullet
3908 @item @b{post-reset}
3909 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3910 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3911 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3912 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3913 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3914
3915 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3916 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3917 of any particular target.
3918 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3919 @item @b{setup}
3920 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3921 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3922 @item @b{tap-disable}
3923 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3924 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3925 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3926 @item @b{tap-enable}
3927 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3928 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3929 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3930 @end itemize
3931
3932 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3933 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3934 contents to be accurate), you might:
3935
3936 @example
3937 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3938 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3939 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3940 @}
3941 @end example
3942
3943
3944 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3945 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3946 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3947 @cindex jrc
3948
3949 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3950 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3951 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3952 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3953 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3954
3955 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3956 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3957 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3958 be visible.
3959 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3960 ignores, such as:
3961
3962 @itemize
3963 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3964 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3965 TAPs receive new instructions.
3966 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3967 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3968 @end itemize
3969
3970 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3971 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3972 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3973 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3974
3975 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3976 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3977
3978 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3979 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3980 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3981 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3982 should define TAP event handlers using
3983 code that looks something like this:
3984
3985 @example
3986 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3987 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3988 @}
3989 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3990 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3991 @}
3992 @end example
3993
3994 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3995
3996 @example
3997 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3998 @end example
3999
4000 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4001 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4002 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4003 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4004
4005 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4006 If necessary, disables the tap
4007 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4008 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4009 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4010 and "0" if it is disabled.
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4014 If necessary, enables the tap
4015 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4016 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4017 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4018 and "0" if it is disabled.
4019 @end deffn
4020
4021 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4022 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4023 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4024 and "0" if it is disabled.
4025
4026 @quotation Note
4027 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4028 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4029 @end quotation
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @anchor{autoprobing}
4033 @section Autoprobing
4034 @cindex autoprobe
4035 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4036
4037 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4038 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4039 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4040 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4041
4042 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4043 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4044 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4045 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4046 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4047 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4048 right when they come out of reset).
4049
4050 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4051
4052 @example
4053 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4054 reset_config trst_and_srst
4055 jtag_rclk 8
4056 @end example
4057
4058 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4059 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4060
4061 @enumerate
4062 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4063 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4064 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4065 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4066 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4067 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4068 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4069 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4070 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4071 that is discovered.
4072 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4073 register, it will report it.
4074 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4075 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4076 @end enumerate
4077
4078 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4079 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4080 that's a bit more complex:
4081
4082 @example
4083 clock speed 8 kHz
4084 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4085 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4086 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4087 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4088 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4089 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4090 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4091 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4092 @end example
4093
4094 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4095 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4096 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4097 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4098 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4099 and so forth.
4100
4101 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4102 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4103 @cindex DAP declaration
4104
4105 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4106 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4107 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4108 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4109 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4110
4111 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4112
4113 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4114 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4115 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4116 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4117 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4118
4119 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4120
4121 @itemize @bullet
4122 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4123 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4124 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4125 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4126 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4127 @end itemize
4128 @end deffn
4129
4130 @deffn Command {dap names}
4131 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4132 for TCL scripting.
4133 @end deffn
4134
4135 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4136 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4137 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 @deffn Command {dap init}
4141 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4142 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4143 initialization, too.
4144 @end deffn
4145
4146 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4147
4148 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4149 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4150 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4151 @end deffn
4152
4153 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4154 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4158 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4159 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4160 or set a new value @var{value}.
4161 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4162 @end deffn
4163
4164 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4165 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4166 @end deffn
4167
4168 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4169 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4170 value @var{value}.
4171
4172 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4173 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4174 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4175
4176 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4177 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4178 @end deffn
4179
4180 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4181 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4182 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4183 @end deffn
4184
4185 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4186 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4187 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4188 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4192 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4193
4194 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4195 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4196 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4197 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4198 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4199 for details.
4200
4201 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4202 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4203 the pattern:
4204 @example
4205 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4206 @end example
4207
4208 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4209 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4210 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4211 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4212 @example
4213 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4214 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4215 @end example
4216
4217 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4218 @example
4219 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4220 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4221 @end example
4222
4223 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4224 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4225
4226 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4227 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4228 example with a proper dap name:
4229 @example
4230 xxx.dap apcsw default
4231 @end example
4232 @end deffn
4233
4234 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4235 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4236 Disabled by default
4237 @end deffn
4238
4239
4240 @node CPU Configuration
4241 @chapter CPU Configuration
4242 @cindex GDB target
4243
4244 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4245 You can also access these targets without GDB
4246 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4247 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4248 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4249 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4250
4251 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4252 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4253
4254 @section Target List
4255 @cindex target, current
4256 @cindex target, list
4257
4258 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4259 where each member has a name.
4260 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4261 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4262 (plural!) command.
4263 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4264 look like with more than one:
4265 @verbatim
4266 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4267 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4268 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4269 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4270 @end verbatim
4271
4272 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4273 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4274 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4275 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4276 space seen by that current target.
4277 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4278 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4279 are examples; and there are many more.
4280
4281 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4282
4283 @deffn Command {target current}
4284 Returns the name of the current target.
4285 @end deffn
4286
4287 @deffn Command {target names}
4288 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4289 @example
4290 foreach t [target names] @{
4291 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4292 @}
4293 @end example
4294 @end deffn
4295
4296 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4297 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4298
4299 @deffn Command targets [name]
4300 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4301 command names are singular.}
4302
4303 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4304 targets in a user friendly form.
4305
4306 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4307 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4308 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @section Target CPU Types
4312 @cindex target type
4313 @cindex CPU type
4314
4315 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4316 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4317 when calling @command{target create}.
4318 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4319 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4320 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4321 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4322 what core-specific commands may be available
4323 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4324 and more.
4325
4326 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4327 since there's a command to list them.
4328
4329 @anchor{targettypes}
4330 @deffn Command {target types}
4331 Lists all supported target types.
4332 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4333
4334 @itemize @bullet
4335 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4336 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4337 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4338 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4339 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4340 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4341 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4342 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4343 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4344 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4345 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4346 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4347 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4348 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4349 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4350 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4351 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4352 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4353 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4354 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4355 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4356 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4357 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4358 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4359 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4360 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4361 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4362 @itemize @minus
4363 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4364 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4365 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4366 @end itemize
4367 And two debug interfaces cores:
4368 @itemize @minus
4369 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4370 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4371 @end itemize
4372 @end itemize
4373 @end deffn
4374
4375 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4376 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4377 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4378 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4379 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4380 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4381 reflect design generations;
4382 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4383 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4384
4385 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4386 @section Target Configuration
4387
4388 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4389 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4390 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4391 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4392 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4393
4394 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4395 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4396 optional parts.
4397 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4398 command, created as part of target creation.
4399
4400 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4401 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4402 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4403 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4404 to be much more board-specific.
4405 The key steps you use might look something like this
4406
4407 @example
4408 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4409 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4410 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4411 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4412 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4413 @end example
4414
4415 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4416 on-chip SRAM.
4417 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4418 writes to target memory;
4419 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4420 GDB memory checksumming;
4421 and more.
4422
4423 @quotation Warning
4424 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4425 inaccessible when application code
4426 (such as an operating system)
4427 enables or disables the MMU.
4428 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4429 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4430 easy access to other addresses needed.
4431 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4432 @end quotation
4433
4434 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4435 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4436 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4437 controllers.
4438 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4439 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4440 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4441
4442 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4443 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4444 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4445 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4446 purposes including additional configuration.
4447
4448 @itemize @bullet
4449 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4450 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4451 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4452 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4453
4454 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4455 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4456 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4457 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4458 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4459 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4460 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4461
4462 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4463 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4464 @end itemize
4465 @end deffn
4466
4467 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4468 The options accepted by this command may also be
4469 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4470 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4471 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4472
4473 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4474 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4475 and changing its endianness.
4476
4477 @itemize @bullet
4478
4479 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4480 used to access this target.
4481
4482 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4483 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4484 create and manage DAP instances.
4485
4486 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4487 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4488
4489 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4490 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4491 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4492 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4493 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4494 same event name assigns only one handler.
4495
4496 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4497 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4498
4499 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4500 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4501 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4502 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4503 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4504 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4505 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4506
4507 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4508 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4509 or virtual address is being used.
4510
4511 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4512 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4513
4514 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4515 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4516 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4517 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4518 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4519
4520 @anchor{rtostype}
4521 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4522 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4523 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4524 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4525 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4526
4527 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4528 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4529 access the target for debugging.
4530
4531 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4532 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4533 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4534 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4535
4536 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4537 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4538 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4539 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4540 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4541
4542 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4543 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4544 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4545 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4546 command @command{gdb_port}.
4547 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4548 @end itemize
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @section Other $target_name Commands
4552 @cindex object command
4553
4554 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4555 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4556
4557 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4558 Once a button is created a button
4559 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4560 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4561 configure it like this:
4562
4563 @example
4564 # Create
4565 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4566 # Modify
4567 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4568 # Query
4569 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4570 # Report
4571 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4572 @end example
4573
4574 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4575 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4576
4577 @example
4578 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4579 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4580 @end example
4581
4582 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4583
4584 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4585 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4586 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4587 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4588 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4589 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4590 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4591 They are not otherwise documented here.
4592 @end deffn
4593
4594 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4595 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4596 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4597 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4598 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4599 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4600 the target side uses raw memory.
4601
4602 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4603 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4604 The script orientation comes from working with data
4605 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4606 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4607 and neither store nor return those values.
4608
4609 @itemize
4610 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4611 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4612 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4613 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4614 @end itemize
4615 @end deffn
4616
4617 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4618 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4619 @command{$target_name configure}
4620 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4621 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4622 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4623 There are a few special cases:
4624
4625 @itemize @bullet
4626 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4627 event named @var{event_name}.
4628 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4629 two parameters.
4630 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4631 This is a special case because this is set using
4632 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4633 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4634 @end itemize
4635
4636 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4637 all the targets you might use something like this:
4638
4639 @example
4640 foreach name [target names] @{
4641 set y [$name cget -endian]
4642 set z [$name cget -type]
4643 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4644 $x $name $y $z]
4645 @}
4646 @end example
4647 @end deffn
4648
4649 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4650 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4651 Displays the current target state:
4652 @code{debug-running},
4653 @code{halted},
4654 @code{reset},
4655 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4656 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4660 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4661 currently associated with this target.
4662 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4663 @end deffn
4664
4665 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4666 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4667 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4668 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4669 @end deffn
4670
4671 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4672 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4673 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4674 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4675 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4676 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4677 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4678 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4679 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4683 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4684 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4685 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4686 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4687 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4688 @end deffn
4689
4690 @anchor{targetevents}
4691 @section Target Events
4692 @cindex target events
4693 @cindex events
4694 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4695 For example:
4696 @itemize @bullet
4697 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4698 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4699 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4700 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4701 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4702 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4703 to set up system clocks or
4704 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4705 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4706 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4707 @end itemize
4708
4709 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4710 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4711 @command{target create ... -event}.
4712
4713 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4714 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4715 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4716
4717 @example
4718 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4719 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4720 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4721 @}
4722 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4723 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4724 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4725 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4726 @}
4727 @end example
4728
4729 The following target events are defined:
4730
4731 @itemize @bullet
4732 @item @b{debug-halted}
4733 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4734 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4735 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4736 @item @b{early-halted}
4737 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4738 @item @b{examine-start}
4739 @* Before target examine is called.
4740 @item @b{examine-end}
4741 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4742 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4743 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4744 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4745 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4746 connect GDB to running target.
4747 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4748 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4749 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4750 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4751 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4752 is in RAM or read only memory.
4753 Default is @code{halt}
4754 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4755 @* When GDB disconnects
4756 @item @b{gdb-end}
4757 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4758 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4759 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4760 @code{reset init})
4761 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4762 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4763 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4764 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4765 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4766 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4767 @item @b{gdb-start}
4768 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4769 @item @b{halted}
4770 @* The target has halted
4771 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4772 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4773 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4774 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4775 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4776 @item @b{reset-assert}
4777 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4778 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4779 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4780 it instead of asserting SRST.
4781 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4782 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4783 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4784 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4785 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4786 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4787 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4788 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4789 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4790 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4791 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4792 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4793 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4794 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4795 released on the scan chain.
4796 @item @b{reset-end}
4797 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4798 @item @b{reset-init}
4799 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4800 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4801
4802 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4803 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4804 multiplexing, and so on.
4805 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4806 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4807 @item @b{reset-start}
4808 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4809 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4810
4811 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4812 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4813 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4814 @item @b{resume-start}
4815 @* Before any target is resumed
4816 @item @b{resume-end}
4817 @* After all targets have resumed
4818 @item @b{resumed}
4819 @* Target has resumed
4820 @item @b{trace-config}
4821 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4822 @end itemize
4823
4824 @node Flash Commands
4825 @chapter Flash Commands
4826
4827 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4828 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4829 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4830 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4831 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4832 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4833 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4834 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4835 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4836
4837 Flash Steps:
4838 @enumerate
4839 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4840 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4841 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4842 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4843 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4844 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4845 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4846 @item GDB Flashing
4847 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4848 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4849 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4850 @end enumerate
4851
4852 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4853 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4854 so that it can't boot.
4855 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4856 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4857
4858 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4859 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4860 @cindex flash configuration
4861
4862 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4863 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4864 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4865 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4866 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4867 see the driver-specific documentation.
4868
4869 @itemize @bullet
4870 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4871 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4872 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4873 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4874 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4875 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4876 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4877 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4878 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4879 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4880 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4881 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4882 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4883 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4884 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4885 commands to the flash controller.
4886 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4887 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4888 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4889 for more information.
4890 @end itemize
4891 @quotation Note
4892 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4893 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4894 @end quotation
4895 @end deffn
4896
4897 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4898 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4899 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4900 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4901 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4902 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4903 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn Command {flash list}
4907 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4908 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4909 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4910 @end deffn
4911
4912 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4913 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4914 depends on the flash type.
4915 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4916 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4917 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4918 but most don't bother.
4919 @end deffn
4920
4921 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4922 @cindex flash erasing
4923 @cindex flash reading
4924 @cindex flash writing
4925 @cindex flash programming
4926 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4927
4928 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4929 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4930 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4931 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4932 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4933
4934 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4935 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4936 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4937 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4938 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4939
4940 @quotation Note
4941 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4942 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4943 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4944 back to a flash bank.
4945 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4946 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4947 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4948 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4949 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4950 @end quotation
4951
4952 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4953 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4954 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4955 disabled first.
4956 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4957 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4958 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4959
4960 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4961 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4962 up to and including @var{last}.
4963 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4964 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4965 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4966 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4967 @end deffn
4968
4969 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4970 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4971 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4972 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4973 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4974 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4975 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4976 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4977 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4978 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4979 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4980 before erase starts.
4981 @end deffn
4982
4983 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4984 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4985 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4986 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4987 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4988 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4989 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4990 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4991 before issuing this command.
4992 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4993 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4994 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4995 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4996 @end deffn
4997 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4998
4999 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5000 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5001 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5002 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5003 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5004 @end deffn
5005
5006 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5007 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5008 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5009 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5010 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5011 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5012 @end deffn
5013
5014 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5015 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5016 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5017 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5018 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5019 @end deffn
5020
5021 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5022 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5023 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5024 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5025 to the base address for each section in the image.
5026 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5027 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5028 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5029 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5030 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5031 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5032 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5033 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5034 each image section.
5035
5036 @quotation Warning
5037 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5038 data you want to preserve.
5039 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5040 sections might be erased with no notice.
5041 @itemize
5042 @item
5043 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5044 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5045 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5046 @item
5047 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5048 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5049 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5050 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5051 @end itemize
5052 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5053 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5054 @end quotation
5055
5056 @end deffn
5057
5058 @section Other Flash commands
5059 @cindex flash protection
5060
5061 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5062 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5063 and display that status.
5064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5065 @end deffn
5066
5067 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5068 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5069 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5070
5071 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5072 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5073 and possibly stale information.
5074 @end deffn
5075
5076 @anchor{flashprotect}
5077 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5078 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5079 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5080 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5081 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5082 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5083 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5084 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5085 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5086 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5087 @end deffn
5088
5089 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5090 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5091 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5092 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @anchor{program}
5096 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5097 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5098 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5099 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5100 @end deffn
5101
5102 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5103 @section Flash Driver List
5104 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5105 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5106 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5107
5108 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5109 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5110 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5111
5112 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5113
5114 @itemize
5115 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5116 @end itemize
5117
5118 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5119 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5120 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5121 @example
5122 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5123 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5124 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5125 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5126 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5127 @end example
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @subsection External Flash
5131
5132 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5133 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5134 @cindex CFI
5135 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5136 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5137 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5138 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5139 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5140 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5141 configure a bus and its timings), or
5142 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5143 on the flash chip.
5144 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5145 speed up operation.
5146
5147 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5148
5149 @itemize
5150 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5151 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5152 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5153 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5154 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5155 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5156 @end itemize
5157
5158 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5159 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5160
5161 @example
5162 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5163 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5164 @end example
5165
5166 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5167 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5168 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5169
5170 @example
5171 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5172 @end example
5173
5174 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5175 @end deffn
5176
5177 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5178 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5179 @cindex SPI
5180 @cindex jtagspi
5181 @cindex bscan_spi
5182 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5183 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5184 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5185 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5186 accessed through JTAG.
5187
5188 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5189 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5190 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5191 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5192 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5193 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5194
5195 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5196 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5197 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5198 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5199 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5200 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5201 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5202 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5203
5204 @itemize
5205 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5206 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5207 @var{USER1} instruction.
5208 @end itemize
5209
5210 @example
5211 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5212 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5213 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5214 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5215 @end example
5216 @end deffn
5217
5218 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5219 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5220 @cindex xcf
5221 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5222 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5223 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5224 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5225 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5226
5227 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5228 command accepts additional parameters:
5229 @itemize
5230 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5231 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5232 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5233 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5234 in master mode.
5235 @end itemize
5236 @example
5237 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5238 @end example
5239 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5240 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5241 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5242 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5243 dedicated sector.
5244 @end deffn
5245
5246 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5247 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5248 button.
5249 @example
5250 xcf configure 0
5251 @end example
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 Additional driver notes:
5255 @itemize
5256 @item Only single revision supported.
5257 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5258 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5259 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5260 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5261 @end itemize
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5265 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5266 @cindex SPIFI
5267 @cindex lpcspifi
5268 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5269 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5270 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5271
5272 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5273 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5274 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5275 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5276 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5277
5278 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5279 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5280 are configured by the driver.
5281
5282 @example
5283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5284 @end example
5285
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5289 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5290 @cindex SMI
5291 @cindex stmsmi
5292 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5293 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5294 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5295 SPI flash devices.
5296 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5297 flash devices can be connected.
5298
5299 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5300 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5301 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5302 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5303 the flash content.
5304
5305 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5306 to identify the memory bank.
5307 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5308 flash size, are detected automatically.
5309
5310 @example
5311 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5312 @end example
5313
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5317 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5318 Microcontroller platform.
5319
5320 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5321 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5322
5323 @example
5324 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5325 @end example
5326
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5330 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5331 @cindex ath79
5332 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5333 chip selects.
5334 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5335 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5336 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5337 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5338 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5339 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5340
5341 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5342 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5343 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5344 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5345 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5346 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5347 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5348 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5349 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5350 with the default CS0.
5351 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5352 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5353 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5354
5355 @example
5356 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5357
5358 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5359 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5360 # banks.
5361 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5362 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5363 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5364 @end example
5365
5366 @end deffn
5367
5368 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5369 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5370 @cindex fespi
5371
5372 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5373
5374 @example
5375 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5376 @end example
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5380
5381 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5382 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5383 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5384 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5385 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5386 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5387
5388 @example
5389 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5390 @end example
5391 @end deffn
5392
5393 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5394 @cindex ambiqmicro
5395 @cindex apollo
5396 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5397 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5398 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5399 with the target using SWD.
5400
5401 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5402 the device class of the MCU.
5403 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5404 to set up the flash banks.
5405 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5406 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5407
5408 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5409 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5410 and the second bank starts after the first.
5411
5412 @example
5413 # Flash bank 0
5414 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5415 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5416 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5417 $_TARGETNAME
5418 @end example
5419
5420 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5421 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5422 are available to the user.
5423
5424 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5425
5426 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5427 Erase entire bank.
5428 @end deffn
5429 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5430 Erase device pages.
5431 @end deffn
5432 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5433 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5434 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5435 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5436 the flash.
5437 @end deffn
5438 @end deffn
5439
5440 @anchor{at91samd}
5441 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5442 @cindex at91samd
5443 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5444 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5445 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5446
5447 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5448 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5449 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5450 processor to be halted.
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5454 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5455 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5456 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5457 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5458 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5459
5460 @example
5461 at91samd set-security enable
5462 @end example
5463 @end deffn
5464
5465 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5466 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5467 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5468 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5469 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5470 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5471 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5472 in order to disable this feature.
5473
5474 @example
5475 at91samd eeprom
5476 at91samd eeprom 1024
5477 @end example
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5481 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5482 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5483 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5484 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5485 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5486
5487 @example
5488 at91samd bootloader
5489 at91samd bootloader 16384
5490 @end example
5491 @end deffn
5492
5493 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5494 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5495 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5496 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5497 @end deffn
5498
5499 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5500 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5501 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5502 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5503 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5504 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5505 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5506 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5507
5508 @example
5509 # Read user row
5510 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5511 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5512 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5513 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5514 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5515 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5516 @end example
5517 @end deffn
5518
5519 @end deffn
5520
5521 @anchor{at91sam3}
5522 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5523 @cindex at91sam3
5524 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5525 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5526 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5527 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5528 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5529 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5530 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5531 chips are confirmed.}
5532
5533 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5534 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5535 the following fixed locations:
5536
5537 @example
5538 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5539 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5540 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5541 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5542 @end example
5543
5544 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5545 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5546 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5547
5548 @itemize
5549 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5550 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5551 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5552 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5553 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5554 @end itemize
5555
5556 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5557
5558 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5559 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5560 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5561 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5562 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5563 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5564 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5565
5566 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5567 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5568 @end deffn
5569
5570 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5571 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5572 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5573 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5574 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5575 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5576 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5577 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5578 @end deffn
5579
5580 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5581 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5582 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5583 @end deffn
5584 @end deffn
5585
5586 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5587 @cindex at91sam4
5588 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5589 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5590 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5594 @cindex at91sam4l
5595 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5596 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5597 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5598
5599 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5600 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5601 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5602 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5603 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5604 @end deffn
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5608 @cindex atsamv
5609 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5610 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5611 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5612 @end deffn
5613
5614 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5615 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5616 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5617 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5618 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5619
5620 @example
5621 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5622 @end example
5623
5624 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5625 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5626
5627 @itemize
5628 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5629 @item @var{banks}
5630 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5631 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5632 @item @var{pages_size}
5633 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5634 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5635 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5636 @end itemize
5637
5638 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5639 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5640 will be autoconfigured.
5641 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5642
5643 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5644 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5645 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5646 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5647 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5648
5649 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5650 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5651 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5652 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5653 are not truly general purpose).
5654 @quotation Note
5655 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5656 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5657 @end quotation
5658 @end deffn
5659 @end deffn
5660
5661 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5662 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5663 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5664 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5668 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5669 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5670 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5671
5672 @example
5673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5674 @end example
5675
5676 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5677 each single sector one by one.
5678
5679 @example
5680 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5681 @end example
5682
5683 @example
5684 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5685 @end example
5686
5687 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5688 @end deffn
5689
5690 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5691 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5692 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5693 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5694 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5695 starts at address 0.
5696
5697 @example
5698 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5699 @end example
5700 @end deffn
5701
5702 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5703 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5704 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5705 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5706 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5707 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5708 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5709 and programming the serial flash.
5710
5711 @example
5712 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5713 @end example
5714 @end deffn
5715
5716 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5717 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5718 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5719 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5720 autoconfigures itself.
5721 @example
5722 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5723 @end example
5724 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5725 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5726 this via the following command:
5727 @example
5728 efm32 debuglock num
5729 @end example
5730 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5731 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5732 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5733 supported.}
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5737 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5738 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5739 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5740 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5741 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5742
5743 @example
5744 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5745 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5746 @end example
5747
5748 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5749 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5750 @end deffn
5751
5752 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5753 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5754 is an uncommon operation.}
5755 @end deffn
5756 @end deffn
5757
5758 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5759 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5760 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5761 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5762 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5763 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5764 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5765
5766 @example
5767 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5768 @end example
5769 @end deffn
5770
5771 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5772 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5773 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5774 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5775 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5776 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5777 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5778 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5779 characters) ignored.
5780
5781 @example
5782 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5783 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5784 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5785 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5786 @end example
5787 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5788 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5789 @end deffn
5790
5791 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5792 @cindex kinetis
5793 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5794 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5795 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5796 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5797 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5798 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5799
5800 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5801 @itemize
5802 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5803 @end itemize
5804
5805 @example
5806 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5807 @end example
5808
5809 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5810 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5811 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5812 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5816 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5817 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5818 set by 'flash protect' command.
5819 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5820 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5821 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5822 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5823 with the rest of a flash image.
5824 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5825 @end deffn
5826
5827 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5828 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5829 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5833 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5834 @end deffn
5835
5836 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5837 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5838 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5839 @end deffn
5840
5841 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5842 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5843 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5844 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5845 command completes.
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5849 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5850 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5851 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5852 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5853
5854 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5855 Program Partition command.
5856
5857 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5858 Reset the device after partition setting.
5859
5860 Show partition size:
5861 @example
5862 kinetis nvm_partition info
5863 @end example
5864
5865 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5866 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5867 @example
5868 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5869 @end example
5870
5871 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5872 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5873 @example
5874 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5875 @end example
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5879 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5880 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5881 @end deffn
5882
5883 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5884 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5885 Command disables watchdog timer.
5886 @end deffn
5887 @end deffn
5888
5889 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5890 @cindex kinetis_ke
5891 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5892 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5893 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5894 autoconfigures itself.
5895 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5896
5897 @example
5898 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5899 @end example
5900
5901 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5902 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5903 @end deffn
5904
5905 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5906 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5907 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5908 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5909 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5913 Command disables watchdog timer.
5914 @end deffn
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5918 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5919 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5920 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
5921 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
5922
5923 @quotation Note
5924 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5925 driver:
5926 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5927 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5928 @end quotation
5929
5930 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
5931 which must appear in the following order:
5932
5933 @itemize
5934 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5935 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5936 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5937 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5938 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5939 LPC43x[2357])
5940 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5941 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5942 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5943 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5944 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5945 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5946 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
5947 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5948 at which the core is running
5949 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5950 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5951 @quotation Note
5952 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5953 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5954 However, if you do provide it,
5955 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5956 @end quotation
5957 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
5958 ROM IAP entry point.
5959 @end itemize
5960
5961 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5962
5963 @example
5964 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5965 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5966 @end example
5967
5968 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5969 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5970 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5971 @end deffn
5972 @end deffn
5973
5974 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5975 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5976 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5977 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5978 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5979 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5980
5981 @example
5982 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5983 @end example
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5987 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5988 from NXP.
5989
5990 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5991 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5992 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5993 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5994 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5995 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5996 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5997 you start the PLL.
5998
5999 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6000
6001 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6002 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6003 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6004
6005 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6006 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6007 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6008 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6009 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6010 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6011 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6012
6013 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6014 @example
6015 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6016 @end example
6017
6018 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6019 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6020 @code{flash banks} command.
6021
6022 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6023 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6024 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6025 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6026 a known signature.
6027 Example:
6028 @example
6029 lpc2900 signature 0
6030 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6031 @end example
6032 @end deffn
6033
6034 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6035 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6036 saves it to a file in binary format.
6037 Example:
6038 @example
6039 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6040 @end example
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6044 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6045 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6046 command:
6047
6048 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6049 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6050 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6051 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6052
6053 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6054 Example:
6055 @example
6056 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6057 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6058 @end example
6059 @end deffn
6060
6061 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6062 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6063 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6064 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6065 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6066 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6067 912 bytes.
6068 @quotation Attention
6069 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6070 @end quotation
6071 Example:
6072 @example
6073 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6074 @end example
6075 @end deffn
6076
6077 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6078 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6079 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6080 after the next power cycle.
6081 @quotation Attention
6082 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6083 @end quotation
6084 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6085 Example:
6086 @example
6087 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6088 flash info 0
6089 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6090 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6091 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6092 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6093 @end example
6094 @end deffn
6095
6096 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6097 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6098 effective after the next power cycle.
6099 @quotation Attention
6100 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6101 @end quotation
6102 Examples:
6103 @example
6104 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6105 @end example
6106 @end deffn
6107 @end deffn
6108
6109 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6110 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6111 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6112 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6113
6114 @example
6115 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6116 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6117 @end example
6118
6119 @itemize @bullet
6120 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6121 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6122 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6123 @end itemize
6124
6125 Example usage:
6126 @example
6127 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6128 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6129 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6130 @} else @{
6131 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6132 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6133 @}
6134 @end example
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6138 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6139 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6140 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6141 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6142 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6143
6144 @example
6145 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6146 @end example
6147
6148 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6149 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6150 only the main program flash.
6151
6152 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6153 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6154 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6155 @end deffn
6156
6157 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6158 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6159 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6160 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6161
6162 To erase and program the BSL:
6163 @example
6164 msp432 bsl unlock
6165 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6166 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6167 msp432 bsl lock
6168 @end example
6169 @end deffn
6170 @end deffn
6171
6172 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6173 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6174 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6175 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6176 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6177 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6178 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6179 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6180 also have division into regions: main and info.
6181 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6182 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6183
6184 @example
6185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6186 @end example
6187
6188 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6189
6190 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6191 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6192 @end deffn
6193
6194 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6195 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6196 @end deffn
6197
6198 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6199 Erase all userflash including info region.
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6203 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6204 @end deffn
6205
6206 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6207 Check sectors protect.
6208 @end deffn
6209
6210 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6211 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6215 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6216 @end deffn
6217
6218 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6219 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6223 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6224 @end deffn
6225
6226 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6227 Show information about flash driver.
6228 @end deffn
6229
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6233 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6234 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6235 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6236 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6237
6238 @example
6239 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6240 @end example
6241
6242 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6243
6244 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6245 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6246 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6247 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6248 code.
6249 @end deffn
6250
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6254 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6255 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6256
6257 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6258 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6259 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6260 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6261
6262 @example
6263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6264 @end example
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6268 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6269 and integrate flash memory.
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6274 @end example
6275
6276 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6277 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6278 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6279 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6280 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6281 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6282 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6283 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6284 @end deffn
6285 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6286 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6287 This will remove any Code Protection.
6288 @end deffn
6289 @end deffn
6290
6291 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6292 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6293 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6294 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6295 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6296
6297 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6298 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6299
6300 @example
6301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6302 @end example
6303
6304 psoc4-specific commands
6305 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6306 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6307
6308 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6309 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6310
6311 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6312 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6313 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6314
6315 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6319 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6320
6321 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6322 @end deffn
6323 @end deffn
6324
6325 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6326 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6327 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6328 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6329 apart from the base address.
6330
6331 @example
6332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6333 @end example
6334
6335 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6336 @quotation Attention
6337 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6338 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6339 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6340 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6341 @end quotation
6342
6343 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6344
6345 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6346 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6347 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6348 @end deffn
6349 @end deffn
6350
6351 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6352 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6353 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6354 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6355 apart from the base address.
6356
6357 @example
6358 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6359 @end example
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6363 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6364 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6365 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6366
6367 @example
6368 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6369 @end example
6370
6371 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6372
6373 @itemize
6374 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6375 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6376 @end itemize
6377
6378 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6379
6380 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6381 @quotation Attention
6382 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6383 after successful write.
6384 @end quotation
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6388 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6389 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6390 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6391
6392 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6393 @itemize @bullet
6394 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6395 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6396 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6397 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6398 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6399 row size: 512 bytes.
6400 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6401 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6402 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6403 operation will erase row automatically.
6404 @end itemize
6405
6406 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6407 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6408
6409 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6410
6411 @example
6412 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6413 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6414 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6415 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6416 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6417 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6418
6419 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6420 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6421 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6422 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6423 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6424 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6425 @end example
6426
6427 psoc6-specific commands
6428 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6429 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6430 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6431 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6432 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6433 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6437 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6438 by @command{flash banks}.
6439 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6440 @end deffn
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6444 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6445 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6446 and SWD interface.
6447 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6448 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6449
6450 @example
6451 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6452 @end example
6453
6454 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6455
6456 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6457 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6458 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6459 @end deffn
6460
6461 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6462 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6463 @end deffn
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6467 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6468 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6469 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6470 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6471
6472 @example
6473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6474 @end example
6475
6476 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6477 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6478 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6479 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6480 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6481 disabled.
6482
6483 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6484 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6485 @quotation Warning
6486 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6487 applied to all of them.
6488 @end quotation
6489 @end deffn
6490 @end deffn
6491
6492 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6493 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6494 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6495 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6496 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6497
6498 @example
6499 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6500 @end example
6501
6502 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6503 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6504 the flash driver.
6505
6506 @example
6507 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6508 @end example
6509
6510 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6511 as per the following example.
6512 @example
6513 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6514 @end example
6515
6516 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6517
6518 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6519 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6520 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6524 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6525 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6526 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6530 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6531 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6532 @end deffn
6533
6534 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6535 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6536 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6537 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6541 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6542 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6546 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6547 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6548 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6549 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6550 @end deffn
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6554 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6555 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6556 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6557 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6558
6559 @example
6560 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6561 @end example
6562
6563 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6564 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6565 the flash driver.
6566
6567 @example
6568 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6569 @end example
6570
6571 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6572
6573 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6574 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6575 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6579 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6580 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6584 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6586 @end deffn
6587
6588 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6589 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6590 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6594 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6595 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6596 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6597 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6598 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6599 @end deffn
6600
6601 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6602 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6603 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6604 @end deffn
6605 @end deffn
6606
6607 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6608 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6609 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6610 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6611 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6612
6613 @example
6614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6615 @end example
6616
6617 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6618 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6619 the flash driver.
6620
6621 @example
6622 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6623 @end example
6624
6625 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6626
6627 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6628 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6629 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6633 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6634 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6638 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6639 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6640 @end deffn
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6644 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6645 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6646 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6647 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6648
6649 @example
6650 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6651 @end example
6652
6653 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6654 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6655 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6656 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6657 second bank.
6658
6659 @example
6660 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6661 @end example
6662
6663 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6664
6665 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6666 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6667 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6668 @end deffn
6669
6670 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6671 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6672 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6676 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6677 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6678 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6679 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6680 @end deffn
6681 @end deffn
6682
6683 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6684 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6685 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6686 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6687 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6688
6689 @example
6690 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6691 @end example
6692
6693 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6694 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6695 the flash driver.
6696
6697 @example
6698 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6699 @end example
6700
6701 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6702
6703 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6704 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6705 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6706 @end deffn
6707
6708 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6709 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6710 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6714 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6719 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6720 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6721 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6722
6723 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6724 @example
6725 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6726 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6727 @end example
6728
6729 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6730 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6731 @end deffn
6732
6733 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6734 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6735 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6736 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6737 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6738
6739 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6740 @example
6741 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6742 @end example
6743
6744 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6745 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6746 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6750 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6751 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6752 @end deffn
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6756 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6757 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6758 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6759 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6760
6761 @example
6762 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6763 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6764 @end example
6765
6766 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6767 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6768 for the specified flash bank.
6769 @end deffn
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6773 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6774 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6775 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6776 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6777
6778 @example
6779 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6780 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6781 @end example
6782
6783 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6784 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6785 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6786
6787 @itemize @bullet
6788 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6789 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6790 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6791 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6792 @end itemize
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6798 @cindex str9xpec
6799
6800 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6801 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6802 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6803 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6804
6805 Here is some background info to help
6806 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6807 the str9:
6808 @enumerate
6809 @item
6810 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6811 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6812 @item
6813 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6814 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6815 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6816 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6817 @end enumerate
6818
6819 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6820 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6821 configured for flash bank 0.
6822 @example
6823 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6824 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6825 jtag_reset 0 1
6826 # turn off target polling
6827 poll off
6828 # disable str9 core
6829 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6830 # read option bytes
6831 str9xpec options_read 0
6832 # re-enable str9 core
6833 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6834 poll on
6835 reset halt
6836 @end example
6837 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6838 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6839 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6840 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6841
6842 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6843
6844 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6845 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6846 @end deffn
6847
6848 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6849 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6850 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6854 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6855 erase the device.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6859 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6863 Configure str9 boot bank.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6867 Configure str9 lvd source.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6871 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6872 @end deffn
6873
6874 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6875 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6876 @end deffn
6877
6878 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6879 Read str9 option bytes.
6880 @end deffn
6881
6882 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6883 Write str9 option bytes.
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6887 unlock str9 device.
6888 @end deffn
6889
6890 @end deffn
6891
6892 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6893 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6894 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6895 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6896
6897 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6898
6899 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6900 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6904 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6905 @end deffn
6906
6907 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6908 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6909 the flash clock.
6910 @end deffn
6911 @end deffn
6912
6913 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
6914 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
6915 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
6916 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6917 correct bank config.
6918
6919 @example
6920 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
6921 @end example
6922 @end deffn
6923
6924 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6925 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6926 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6930 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6931 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6932
6933 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6934
6935 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6936 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6940 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6941 @end deffn
6942
6943 @end deffn
6944
6945 @section NAND Flash Commands
6946 @cindex NAND
6947
6948 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6949 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6950 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6951
6952 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6953 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6954 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6955 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6956 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6957 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6958
6959 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6960 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6961 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6962 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6963 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6964 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6965 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6966 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6967 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6968 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6969
6970 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6971 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6972 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6973 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6974 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6975 every 512 bytes of data.
6976
6977 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6978 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6979 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6980 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6981 ECC mode is used.
6982
6983 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6984 @enumerate
6985 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6986 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6987 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6988 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6989 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6990 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6991 to access that device.
6992 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6993 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6994 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6995 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6996 de-brick a board.
6997 @end enumerate
6998
6999 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7000 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7001 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7002 are only 32 bits wide.
7003 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7004 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7005 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7006 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7007
7008 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7009 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7010 @cindex NAND configuration
7011
7012 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7013 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7014 OpenOCD has initialized.
7015
7016 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7017 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7018 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7019 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7020 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7021 they were a single (larger) device.
7022 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7023 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7024
7025 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7026 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7027 configuration files, not interactively.
7028
7029 @itemize @bullet
7030 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7031 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7032 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7033 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7034 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7035 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7036 commands to the NAND controller.
7037 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7038 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7039 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7040 for more information.
7041 @end itemize
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044 @deffn Command {nand list}
7045 Prints a summary of each device declared
7046 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7047 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7048 @example
7049 > nand list
7050 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7051 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7052 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7053 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7054 >
7055 @end example
7056 @end deffn
7057
7058 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7059 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7060 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7061 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7062 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7063 it with most other NAND commands.
7064 @end deffn
7065
7066 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7067
7068 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7069 @cindex NAND reading
7070 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7071 starting at the specified offset.
7072 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7073
7074 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7075 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7076
7077 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7078 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7079 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7080
7081 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7082 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7083 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7084 method which handled that error correction.
7085
7086 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7087 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7088 @itemize @bullet
7089 @item no oob_* parameter
7090 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7091 @item @code{oob_raw}
7092 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7093 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7094 spare areas associated with each data page.
7095 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7096 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7097 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7098 @item @code{oob_only}
7099 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7100 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7101 spare areas associated with each data page.
7102 @end itemize
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7106 @cindex NAND erasing
7107 @cindex NAND programming
7108 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7109 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7110 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7111 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7112 If those parameters are not specified,
7113 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7114 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7115
7116 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7117 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7118 block marker.
7119 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7120 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7124 @cindex NAND writing
7125 @cindex NAND programming
7126 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7127 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7128 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7129 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7130
7131 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7132 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7133
7134 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7135 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7136 past the end of the device.
7137 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7138 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7139 if that's being written.)
7140
7141 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7142 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7143 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7144
7145 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7146 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7147 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7148 @itemize @bullet
7149 @item no oob_* parameter
7150 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7151 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7152 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7153 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7154 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7155 @item @code{oob_only}
7156 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7157 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7158 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7159 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7160 @item @code{oob_raw}
7161 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7162 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7163 un-altered OOB.
7164 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7165 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7166 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7167 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7168 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7169 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7170 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7171 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7172 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7173 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7174 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7175 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7176 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7177 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7178 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7179 @end itemize
7180 @end deffn
7181
7182 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7183 @cindex NAND verification
7184 @cindex NAND programming
7185 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7186 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7187 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7188
7189 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7190 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7191
7192 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7193 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7194 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7195 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7196 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7197
7198 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7199 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7200 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7201
7202 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7203 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7204 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7205 be removed in a future release.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @subsection Other NAND commands
7209 @cindex NAND other commands
7210
7211 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7212 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7213 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7214 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7215 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7216 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7217 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7218 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7219
7220 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7221 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7222 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7223 @end deffn
7224
7225 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7226 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7227 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7228 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7229 status for each block.
7230 @end deffn
7231
7232 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7233 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7234 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7235
7236 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7237 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7238 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7239 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7240 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7241
7242 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7243 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7244 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7245 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7246 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7247 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7248 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7252 @subsection NAND Driver List
7253 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7254 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7255 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7256
7257 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7258 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7259 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7260 address of the ECC controller.
7261 @example
7262 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7263 @end example
7264 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7265 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7266 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7267 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7268 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7269 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7270 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7271 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7272 @end deffn
7273 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7274 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7275 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7279 properly configured for input or output.
7280 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7281 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7282 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7283 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7284 @end deffn
7285 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7286 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7287 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7288 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7289 @end deffn
7290 @end deffn
7291
7292 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7293 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7294 chips from Texas Instruments.
7295 It takes three extra parameters:
7296 address of the NAND chip;
7297 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7298 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7299 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7300 @example
7301 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7302 @end example
7303 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7304 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7305 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7306 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7307 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7311 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7312 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7313 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7314 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7315 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7316 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7320 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7321 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7322 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7323 @end deffn
7324 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7325
7326 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7327 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7328 should work for this chip as well.
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7332 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7333 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7334 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7335 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7336 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7337 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7338 @example
7339 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7340 @end example
7341 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7342 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7343 without parameter query status.
7344 @end deffn
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7348 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7349 parameter: the address of the controller.
7350 @example
7351 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7352 @end example
7353 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7354 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7355 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7356 change any behavior.
7357 @end deffn
7358
7359 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7360 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7361 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7362 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7363 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7364 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7365 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7366 specialized commands.
7367 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7368 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7369 change any behavior.
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 @section mFlash
7373
7374 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7375 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7376
7377 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7378 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7379 address @var{base}.
7380 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7381 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7382
7383 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7384
7385 @example
7386 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7387 @end example
7388
7389 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7390
7391 @example
7392 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7393 @end example
7394 @end deffn
7395
7396 @subsection mFlash commands
7397 @cindex mFlash commands
7398
7399 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7400 Configure mflash PLL.
7401 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7402 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7403 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7404 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7408 Configure bootable option.
7409 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7410 (4kB) for boot.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7414 Configure storage information.
7415 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7416 written.
7417 @end deffn
7418
7419 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7420 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7421 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7425 Probe mflash.
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7429 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7430 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7431 @end deffn
7432
7433 @node Flash Programming
7434 @chapter Flash Programming
7435
7436 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7437 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7438 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7439
7440 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7441 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7442
7443 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7444 @enumerate
7445 @item 'init' is executed.
7446 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7447 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7448 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7449 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7450 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7451 @end enumerate
7452
7453 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7454
7455 @example
7456 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7457 # are optional parameters
7458 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7459 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7460
7461 # binary files need the flash address passing
7462 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7463 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7464 @end example
7465
7466 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7467 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7468 @cindex PLD
7469 @cindex FPGA
7470
7471 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7472 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7473 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7474 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7475 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7476 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7477 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7478
7479 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7480
7481 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7482 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7483 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7484
7485 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7486 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7487
7488 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7489 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7490 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7491 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7492 behavior.
7493 @end deffn
7494
7495 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7496 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7500 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7501 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7505
7506 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7507 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7508 that particular type of PLD.
7509
7510 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7511 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7512 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7513
7514 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7515 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7516 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7517
7518 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7519 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7520 for FPGA @var{num}.
7521 @end deffn
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @node General Commands
7525 @chapter General Commands
7526 @cindex commands
7527
7528 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7529 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7530 commands are documented elsewhere.
7531
7532 Intent:
7533 @itemize @bullet
7534 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7535 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7536 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7537 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7538
7539 @item @b{From the human}
7540 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7541 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7542
7543 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7544 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7545 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7546
7547 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7548 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7549 port is 5555.
7550 @end itemize
7551
7552
7553 @section Server Commands
7554
7555 @deffn {Command} exit
7556 Exits the current telnet session.
7557 @end deffn
7558
7559 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7560 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7561 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7562 Not every command provides helptext.
7563
7564 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7565 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7566 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7567 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7568 @end deffn
7569
7570 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7571 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7572 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7573 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7574 Useful in connection with script files
7575 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7579 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7580 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7581 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7582
7583 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7584 @example
7585 # redefine shutdown
7586 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7587 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7588 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7589 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7590 original_shutdown
7591 @}
7592 @end example
7593 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7594 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @anchor{debuglevel}
7598 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7599 @cindex message level
7600 Display debug level.
7601 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7602 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7603 Level 0 is error messages only;
7604 level 1 adds warnings;
7605 level 2 adds informational messages;
7606 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7607 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7608 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7609 the command line along with the location of that log
7610 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7611 @xref{Running}.
7612 @end deffn
7613
7614 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7615 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7616 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7617 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7618 @example
7619 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7620 @end example
7621 @end deffn
7622
7623 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7624 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7625 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7629 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7633 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7634 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7635 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7636 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7640 @section Target State handling
7641 @cindex reset
7642 @cindex halt
7643 @cindex target initialization
7644
7645 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7646 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7647 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7648 a current target which is used to perform the
7649 various operations. The current target may be changed
7650 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7651 target which should become current.
7652
7653 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7654 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7655 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7656 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7657 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7658
7659 @emph{With no arguments}:
7660 list all available registers for the current target,
7661 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7662 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7663 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7664 are flagged as such.
7665
7666 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7667 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7668 bypassing any internal cache.
7669
7670 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7671 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7672 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7673 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7674 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7675 relevant module will flush such values.
7676
7677 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7678 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7679
7680 @example
7681 > reg
7682 ===== ARM registers
7683 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7684 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7685 (2) r2 (/32)
7686 ...
7687 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7688 >
7689 @end example
7690 @end deffn
7691
7692 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7693 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7694 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7695 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7696 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7697 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7698 (and enter debug mode).
7699 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7700
7701 @quotation Warning
7702 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7703 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7704 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7705 power mode by gating the core clock;
7706 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7707
7708 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7709 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7710 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7711 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7712 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7713 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7714
7715 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7716 work with a JTAG debugger.
7717 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7718 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7719 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7720 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7721 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7722 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7723 @end quotation
7724
7725 @end deffn
7726
7727 @deffn Command resume [address]
7728 Resume the target at its current code position,
7729 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7730 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @deffn Command step [address]
7734 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7735 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7736 @end deffn
7737
7738 @anchor{resetcommand}
7739 @deffn Command reset
7740 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7741 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7742 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7743 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7744 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7745 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7746
7747 The optional parameter specifies what should
7748 happen after the reset.
7749 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7750 The other options will not work on all systems.
7751 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7752
7753 @itemize @minus
7754 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7755 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7756 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7757 @end itemize
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7761 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7762 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7763 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7764 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7765 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7766 state.
7767 @end deffn
7768
7769 @section I/O Utilities
7770
7771 These commands are available when
7772 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7773 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7774 notably the ZY1000.
7775 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7776
7777 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7778
7779 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7780 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7781 the text file @file{filename}.
7782 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7783 The last string is followed by a newline.
7784 @end deffn
7785
7786 @deffn Command cat filename
7787 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7791 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7792 into @file{dest_filename}.
7793 @end deffn
7794
7795 @deffn Command ip
7796 @emph{No description provided.}
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @deffn Command ls
7800 @emph{No description provided.}
7801 @end deffn
7802
7803 @deffn Command mac
7804 @emph{No description provided.}
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn Command meminfo
7808 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7809 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @deffn Command peek
7813 @emph{No description provided.}
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn Command poke
7817 @emph{No description provided.}
7818 @end deffn
7819
7820 @deffn Command rm filename
7821 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7822 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7823 @end deffn
7824
7825 @deffn Command trunc filename
7826 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7830 @section Memory access commands
7831 @cindex memory access
7832
7833 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7834 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7835 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7836 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7837
7838 @enumerate
7839 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7840 to change the current target.
7841 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7842 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7843 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7844 @end enumerate
7845
7846 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7847 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7848 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7849 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7850 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7851 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7852 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7853 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7854 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7855 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7856 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7857 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7858 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7862 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7863 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7864 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7865 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7866 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7867 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7868 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7869 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7870 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7871 @end deffn
7872
7873 @anchor{imageaccess}
7874 @section Image loading commands
7875 @cindex image loading
7876 @cindex image dumping
7877
7878 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7879 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7880 binary file named @var{filename}.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7884 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7885 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7889 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7890 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7891 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7892 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7893 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7894 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7895 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7896 separately.
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7900 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7901 The file format may optionally be specified
7902 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7903 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7904 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7905 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7906 @example
7907 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7908 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7909 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7910 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7911 $address $length
7912 @}
7913 @end example
7914 @end deffn
7915
7916 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7917 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7918 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7919 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7920 The file format may optionally be specified
7921 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7925 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7926 The file format may optionally be specified
7927 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7928 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7932 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7933 The file format may optionally be specified
7934 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7935 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7936 @end deffn
7937
7938
7939 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7940 @cindex breakpoint
7941 @cindex watchpoint
7942
7943 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7944 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7945 watchpoints.
7946 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7947
7948 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7949 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7950 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7951 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7952 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7953 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7954
7955 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7956 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7957 @end deffn
7958
7959 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7960 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7964 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7968 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7969 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7970 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7971 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7972 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7973 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7974 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7975 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @section Misc Commands
7979
7980 @cindex profiling
7981 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7982 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7983 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7984 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7985 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7986 limit the address range.
7987 @end deffn
7988
7989 @deffn Command {version}
7990 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7994 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7995 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7999 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8000 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8001 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8002
8003 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8004 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8005 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8006 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8007
8008 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8009 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8010 @cindex tracing
8011 @cindex ETM
8012 @cindex ETB
8013
8014 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8015 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8016 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8017
8018 @itemize
8019 @item
8020 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8021 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8022 supports such an interface.
8023 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8024 and trace port support.)
8025 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8026 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8027 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8028 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8029 in the board-specific configuration file.
8030 @item
8031 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8032 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8033 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8034 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8035 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8036 @end itemize
8037
8038 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8039
8040 @quotation Issues
8041 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8042 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8043
8044 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8045 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8046 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8047 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8048 dummy trace port driver}.
8049
8050 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8051 as well as tracing only during specific states
8052 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8053
8054 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8055 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8056 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8057 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8058 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8059
8060 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8061 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8062 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8063 this original style of JTAG access.
8064 @end quotation
8065
8066 @subsection ETM Configuration
8067 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8068
8069 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8070 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8071 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8072
8073 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8074 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8075 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8076 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8077 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8078 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8079 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8080 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8081 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8082
8083 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8084 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8085 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8086
8087 @quotation Warning
8088 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8089 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8090 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8091 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8092 @end quotation
8093
8094 @quotation Note
8095 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8096 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8097 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8098 what CPU activities are traced.
8099 @end quotation
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn Command {etm info}
8103 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8104 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8105 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8106 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8107 @end deffn
8108
8109 @deffn Command {etm status}
8110 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8111 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8112 Did trace data overflow?
8113 Was it triggered?
8114 @end deffn
8115
8116 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8117 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8118 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8119 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8120 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8121
8122 @itemize
8123 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8124 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8125 The value is one of
8126 @option{none} (save nothing),
8127 @option{data} (save data),
8128 @option{address} (save addresses),
8129 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8130 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8131 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8132 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8133 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8134 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8135 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8136 trace stream without an image of the code.
8137 @end itemize
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8141 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8142 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8143 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8144 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8145
8146 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8147 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8148 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8149 @end deffn
8150
8151 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8152
8153 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8154 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8155 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8156
8157 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8158 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8159 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8160 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8161 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8162 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8163 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8164
8165 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8166
8167 @itemize
8168 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8169 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8170 for instruction access within that function's body.
8171 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8172 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8173 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8174 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8175 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8176 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8177 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8178 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8179 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8180 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8181 @item @emph{... more}
8182 @end itemize
8183
8184 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8185 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8186
8187 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8188 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8189 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8193 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8197 Opens an image file.
8198 @end deffn
8199
8200 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8201 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8202 @end deffn
8203
8204 @deffn Command {etm start}
8205 Starts trace data collection.
8206 @end deffn
8207
8208 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8209 Stops trace data collection.
8210 @end deffn
8211
8212 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8213 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8214
8215 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8216
8217 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8218 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8219 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8220 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8221 any trace data collection.}
8222 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8223 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8224 @end deffn
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8228 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8229 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8230 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8231 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8232 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8233 @end deffn
8234 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8235 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8236 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8237 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8238 trace trigger becomes active.
8239
8240 @itemize
8241 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8242 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8243 afterwards.
8244 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8245 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8246 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8247 what caused that event to happen.
8248 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8249 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8250 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8251 how the event caused trouble.
8252 @end itemize
8253 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8254 @end deffn
8255
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8259 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8260 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8261 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8262 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8263
8264 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8265 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8266
8267 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8268 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8269 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8273 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8277 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8278 @end deffn
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8282 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8283 @cindex CTI
8284
8285 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8286 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8287 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8288 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8289 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8290 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8291
8292 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8293 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8294 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8295 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8296 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8297 including additional configuration.
8298 @end deffn
8299
8300 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8301 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8305 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8309 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8313 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8314 @end deffn
8315
8316 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8317 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8318 of the CTI.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn Command {cti names}
8322 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8323 useful in TCL scripting.
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @section Generic ARM
8327 @cindex ARM
8328
8329 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8330 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8331 commands that may be available.
8332
8333 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8334 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8335 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8336 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8337 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8338 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8339 @end deffn
8340
8341 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8342 @cindex disassemble
8343 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8344 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8345 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8346 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8347 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8348 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8349 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8350
8351 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8352 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8353 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8354 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8355 with a handful of exceptions.
8356 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8357 @end deffn
8358
8359 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8360 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8361 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8362 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8363 and using the MCR instruction.
8364 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8365 an ARM register.)
8366 @end deffn
8367
8368 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8369 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8370 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8371 and the MRC instruction.
8372 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8373 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8374 an ARM register.)
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8378 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8379 core mode if necessary.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8383 @cindex ARM semihosting
8384 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8385
8386 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8387 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8388 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8389 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8390 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8391 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8392 @end deffn
8393
8394 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8395 @cindex ARM semihosting
8396 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8397
8398 @example
8399 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8400 @end example
8401
8402 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8403 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8404 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8405 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8409 @cindex ARM semihosting
8410 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8411 status.
8412
8413 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8414 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8415 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8416 debugger.
8417 @end deffn
8418
8419 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8420 @cindex ARM semihosting
8421 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8422
8423 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8424 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8425 the value returned by the target.
8426
8427 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8428 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8429 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8430 encountering a break.
8431
8432 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8433 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8434 to the debugger.
8435 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8436 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8437 request or equivalent").
8438
8439 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8440 this option (default: disabled).
8441 @end deffn
8442
8443 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8444 @cindex ARMv4
8445 @cindex ARMv5
8446
8447 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8448 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8449 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8450 variant.
8451
8452 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8453 @cindex ARM7
8454 @cindex ARM9
8455
8456 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8457 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8458 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8459 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8460
8461 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8462 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8463 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8464 instead of breakpoints.
8465 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8466
8467 This should be
8468 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8469 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8470 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8471 @end deffn
8472
8473 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8474 @cindex DCC
8475 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8476 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8477 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8478
8479 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8480 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8481 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8485 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8486 that don't check completion of the operation.
8487 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8488
8489 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8490 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8491 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8495 @cindex ARM720T
8496
8497 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8498 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8499 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8500 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8501
8502 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8503 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8504 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8505
8506 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8507 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8508 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8512 @cindex ARM9
8513
8514 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8515 integer processors.
8516 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8517
8518 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8519 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8520 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8521 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8522
8523 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8524 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8525 @cindex vector_catch
8526 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8527 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8528 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8529 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8530 to those hardware vectors.
8531
8532 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8533 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8534 vector catch hardware to intercept
8535 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8536 @option{none} of them,
8537 or a list with one or more of the following:
8538 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8539 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8543 @cindex ARM920T
8544
8545 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8546 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8547 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8548 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8549 and ARM9 commands.
8550
8551 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8552 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8553 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8554 @end deffn
8555
8556 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8557 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8558 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8559 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8560 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8561 (Not all registers can be written.)
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8565 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8566 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8567
8568 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8569 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8570 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8571 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8572 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8573 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8574 @end deffn
8575
8576 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8577 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8581 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8585 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8586
8587 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8588 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8589 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8590 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8591 and ARM9 commands.
8592
8593 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8594 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8595
8596 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8597 Print information about the caches found.
8598 @end deffn
8599
8600 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8601 @cindex ARM966E
8602
8603 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8604 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8605 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8606 and ARM9 commands.
8607
8608 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8609 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8610 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8611 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8612 ARM966E-S TRM.
8613 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8614 as required for BIST support.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @subsection XScale specific commands
8618 @cindex XScale
8619
8620 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8621
8622 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8623 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8624 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8625 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8626 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8627 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8628 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8629
8630 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8631 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8632 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8633 the mini-IC.
8634
8635 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8636 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8637 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8638 code layout in memory:
8639 @example
8640 _vectors:
8641 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8642 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8643 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8644 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8645 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8646 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8647 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8648 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8649 .org 0x100
8650 .long real_reset_vector
8651 .long real_ui_handler
8652 .long real_swi_handler
8653 .long real_pf_abort
8654 .long real_data_abort
8655 .long 0 /* unused */
8656 .long real_irq_handler
8657 .long real_fiq_handler
8658 @end example
8659
8660 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8661 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8662 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8663 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8664 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8665 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8666 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8667 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8668 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8669 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8670 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8671 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8672 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8673 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8674 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8675 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8676 software.
8677
8678 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8679 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8680 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8681 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8682
8683 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8684 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8685 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8686 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8687 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8688 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8689 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8690 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8691 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8692
8693 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8694 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8695
8696 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8697 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8701 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8705 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8709 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8710 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8714 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8718 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8719 @end deffn
8720
8721 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8722 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8723 @end deffn
8724
8725 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8726 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8730 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8734 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8735 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8736 and modifying how it is emptied.
8737 @end deffn
8738
8739 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8740 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8741 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8742 The image @var{type} may be one of
8743 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8744 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8745 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8746 @end deffn
8747
8748 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8749 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8750 @cindex vector_catch
8751 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8752 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8753
8754 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8755 @example
8756 0x01 Trap Reset
8757 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8758 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8759 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8760 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8761 0x20 reserved
8762 0x40 Trap IRQ
8763 0x80 Trap FIQ
8764 @end example
8765 @end deffn
8766
8767 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8768 @cindex vector_table
8769
8770 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8771 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8772 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8773 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8774 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8775
8776 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8777
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8781 @cindex ARMv6
8782
8783 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8784 @cindex ARM11
8785
8786 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8787 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8788 which is enabled by default.
8789 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8790 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8791 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8792 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8793 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8794 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8798 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8799 which is enabled by default.
8800 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8801 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8802 @end deffn
8803
8804 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8805 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8806 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8807 they are disabled by default.
8808 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8809 @end deffn
8810
8811 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8812 @cindex vector_catch
8813 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8814 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8815 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8816
8817 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8818 for certain hardware events.
8819 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8820 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8821 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8822 @end deffn
8823
8824 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8825 @cindex ARMv7
8826 @cindex ARMv8
8827
8828 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8829 @cindex Cortex-A
8830
8831 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8832 display information about target caches
8833 @end deffn
8834
8835 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8836 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8837 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8838 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8839 Defaults to 'off'.
8840 @end deffn
8841
8842 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8843 Initialize core debug
8844 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8845 @end deffn
8846
8847 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8848 Disable SMP mode
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8852 Enable SMP mode
8853 @end deffn
8854
8855 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8856 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8860 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8864 configure l2x cache
8865 @end deffn
8866
8867 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8868 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8869 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8870 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8871 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8872 @end deffn
8873
8874 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8875 @cindex Cortex-R
8876
8877 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8878 Initialize core debug
8879 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8883 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886
8887 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8888 @cindex tracing
8889 @cindex SWO
8890 @cindex SWV
8891 @cindex TPIU
8892 @cindex ITM
8893 @cindex ETM
8894
8895 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8896 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8897 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8898
8899 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8900 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8901 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8902 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8903
8904 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8905 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8906 debugger adapter features.
8907
8908 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8909 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8910
8911 Command options:
8912 @itemize @minus
8913 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8914 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8915 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8916 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8917 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8918 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8919 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8920 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8921 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8922 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8923 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8924 coding;
8925 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8926 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8927 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8928 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8929 data is to be output via SWO;
8930 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8931 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8932 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8933 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8934 rate automatically.
8935 @end itemize
8936
8937 Example usage:
8938 @enumerate
8939 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8940 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8941 enough to:
8942 @example
8943 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8944 ...
8945 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8946 ...
8947 @end example
8948 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8949 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8950 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8951 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8952 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8953 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8954 @example
8955 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8956 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8957 @end example
8958 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8959 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8960 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8961 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8962 @example
8963 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8964 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8965 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8966 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8967 @end example
8968 @end enumerate
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8972 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8973 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8974 @end deffn
8975
8976 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8977 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8978 @end deffn
8979
8980 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8981 @cindex Cortex-M
8982
8983 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8984 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8985
8986 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8987 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8988 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8989 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8990 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8991 the step command leaves with the core running.
8992
8993 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8994 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8995 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8996 does.
8997
8998 Default is @option{auto}.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9002 @cindex vector_catch
9003 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9004 for certain hardware events.
9005
9006 Parameters request interception of
9007 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9008 @option{none} of them,
9009 or one or more of the following:
9010 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9011 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9012 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9013 @option{irq_err},
9014 @option{state_err},
9015 @option{chk_err}, or
9016 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9017 @option{reset}.
9018 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9019 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9020 are mapped to HardFault.
9021 UsageFault checks for
9022 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9023 must also be explicitly enabled.
9024
9025 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9026 @end deffn
9027
9028 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9029 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9030 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9031
9032 @itemize @minus
9033 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9034 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9035 @end itemize
9036
9037 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9038 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9039 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9040 to manually reset the peripherals.
9041 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9042
9043 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9044 instead.
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9048 @cindex ARMv8-A
9049 @cindex aarch64
9050
9051 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9052 Display information about target caches
9053 @end deffn
9054
9055 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9056 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9057 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9058 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9059 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9060 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9061 @end deffn
9062
9063 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9064 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9065 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9066 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9067 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9071 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9072 @option{on}.
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9076
9077 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9078 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9079
9080 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9081
9082 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9083 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9084 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9085 @end deffn
9086
9087 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9088 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9089 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9090 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9091 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9092 @end deffn
9093
9094 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9095
9096 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9097 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9098 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9099 @end deffn
9100
9101 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9102
9103 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9104 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9105 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9106 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9107 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9108 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9109 can be collected.
9110
9111 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9112 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9113 tooling.
9114
9115 @quotation Issues
9116 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9117 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9118 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9119 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9120
9121 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9122 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9123 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9124 software operation on the CPU.
9125 @end quotation
9126
9127 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9128 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9129 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9130 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9131 @end deffn
9132
9133 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9134 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9135 @end deffn
9136
9137 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9138 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9139 control is disabled.
9140 @end deffn
9141
9142 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9143 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9144 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9145 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9146
9147 Supported trace formats:
9148 @itemize
9149 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9150 timing to be determined.
9151 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9152 addresses.
9153 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9154 @end itemize
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9158 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9159 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9160 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9161
9162 Supported conditions:
9163 @itemize
9164 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9165 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9166 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9167 instruction matches start data and mask.
9168 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9169 instruction matches start data and mask.
9170 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9171 data and mask.
9172 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9173 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9174 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9175 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9176 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9177 @end itemize
9178 @end deffn
9179
9180 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9181 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9182 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9183 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9184
9185 Supported conditions:
9186 @itemize
9187 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9188 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9189 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9190 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9191 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9192 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9193 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9194 data and mask.
9195 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9196 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9197 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9198 @end itemize
9199 @end deffn
9200
9201 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9202 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9203
9204 Supported triggers:
9205 @itemize
9206 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9207 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9208 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9209 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9210 collection.
9211 @end itemize
9212 @end deffn
9213
9214 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9215
9216 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9217 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9218 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9219 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9223 Display trace configuration.
9224 @end deffn
9225
9226 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9227 Display trace collection status.
9228 @end deffn
9229
9230 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9231 Start manual trace collection.
9232 @end deffn
9233
9234 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9235 Stop manual trace collection.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9239 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9240 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9241 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9242 @option{size} options using DMA.
9243 @end deffn
9244
9245 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9246 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9247 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9248 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9249 @option{size} options using DMA.
9250 @end deffn
9251
9252 @section Intel Architecture
9253
9254 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9255 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9256 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9257 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9258 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9259 @itemize
9260 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9261 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9262 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9263 @end itemize
9264
9265 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9266 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9267 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9268
9269 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9270 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9271 @end deffn
9272
9273 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9274 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9278 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9282 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9286 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9290 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9294
9295 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9296 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9297
9298 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9299 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9300 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9301 @end deffn
9302 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9303 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9304
9305 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9306
9307 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9308 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9309 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9310 @end deffn
9311
9312 @subsection Registers commands
9313 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9314 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9315 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9316
9317 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9318
9319 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9320 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9321 and "timer" groups.
9322
9323 @emph{example:}
9324 @example
9325 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9326 @end example
9327
9328
9329 @end deffn
9330 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9331 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9332
9333 @emph{group} can be "system",
9334 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9335 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9336 @end deffn
9337
9338 @section RISC-V Architecture
9339
9340 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9341 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9342 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9343 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9344 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9345 implement version 0.11.
9346
9347 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9348
9349 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9350 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9351 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9352
9353 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9354
9355 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9356 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9357 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9358
9359 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9360 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9361 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9362 CSRs.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9366 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9367 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9368 @end deffn
9369
9370 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9371 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9372 deasserted.
9373 @end deffn
9374
9375 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9376 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9377 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9381 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9382 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9383 @end deffn
9384
9385 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9386
9387 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9388 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9389 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9390 @example
9391 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9392 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9393 @end example
9394
9395 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9396 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9397 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9401 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9402 @end deffn
9403
9404 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9405
9406 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9407 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9408
9409 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9410 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9411 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9412 dmi_read}.
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9416 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9420 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9421 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9422 @cindex tracing
9423 @cindex libdcc
9424 @cindex DCC
9425 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9426 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9427 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9428 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9429
9430 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9431 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9432 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9433 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9434 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9435 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9436
9437 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9438 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9439 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9440 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9441 The target being debugged may
9442 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9443 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9444 each supported by a command:
9445
9446 @itemize
9447 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9448 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9449 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9450 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9451
9452 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9453 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9454 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9455
9456 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9457 and then displayed at any time.
9458 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9459
9460 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9461 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9462 @end itemize
9463
9464 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9465 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9466 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9467 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9468 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9469 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9470 does the same thing.
9471
9472 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9473 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9474 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9475 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9476 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9477
9478 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9479 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9480 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9481 @end deffn
9482
9483 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9484 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9485 in the order they triggered.
9486 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9487 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9488 history records.
9489 @end deffn
9490
9491 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9492 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9493 they have been triggered.
9494 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9495 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9496 and associates it with that identifier.
9497
9498 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9499 are not related except by this command.
9500 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9501 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504
9505 @node JTAG Commands
9506 @chapter JTAG Commands
9507 @cindex JTAG Commands
9508 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9509 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9510 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9511 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9512 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9513
9514 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9515 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9516
9517 @itemize @bullet
9518 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9519 devices such as a CPUs.
9520 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9521 standard state machine (in parallel)
9522 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9523 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9524 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9525 while the reading previous ones.
9526 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9527 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9528 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9529 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9530 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9531 registers.
9532 @end itemize
9533
9534 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9535
9536 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9537 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9538 the order of TAP state transitions.
9539 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9540 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9541 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9542 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9543 these commands are not available.
9544
9545 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9546 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9547 that specify the entire register.
9548 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9549 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9550 The return value holds the original value of each
9551 of those fields.
9552
9553 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9554 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9555 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9556 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9557 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9558
9559 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9560 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9561
9562 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9563 in that state.
9564 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9565 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9566 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9567
9568 @quotation Warning
9569 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9570 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9571 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9572 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9573 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9574 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9575 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9576 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9577 @end quotation
9578 @end deffn
9579
9580 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9581 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9582 This may be used for performance tuning.
9583
9584 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9585 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9586 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9587 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9588 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9589 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9590 @end deffn
9591
9592 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9593 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9594 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9595 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9596 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9597 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9598
9599 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9600 in that state.
9601 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9602 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9603 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9604
9605 @quotation Note
9606 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9607 register values, unlike data register values.
9608 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9609 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9610 @end quotation
9611 @end deffn
9612
9613 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9614 Set values of reset signals.
9615 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9616 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9617 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9618 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9619 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9620 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9621 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9622
9623 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9624 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9625 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9626 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9627 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9628 instead of the TRST signal.
9629 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9630 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9631 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9632 with handlers for that event.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9636 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9637 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9638 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9639 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9640 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9641 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9642 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9643 The final state must also be stable.
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9647 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9648 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9649 Instructions often need some time
9650 to execute before they take effect.
9651 @end deffn
9652
9653 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9654 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9655
9656 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9657 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9658 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9659 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9660 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9661 @end deffn
9662
9663 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9664 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9665 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9666 must also be enabled.
9667 Default is enabled.
9668 @end deffn
9669
9670 @section TAP state names
9671 @cindex TAP state names
9672
9673 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9674 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9675 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9676 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9677
9678 @itemize @bullet
9679 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9680 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9681 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9682 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9683 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9684 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9685 through the data register
9686 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9687 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9688 for update or more shifting
9689 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9690 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9691 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9692 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9693 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9694 through the instruction register
9695 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9696 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9697 for update or more shifting
9698 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9699 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9700 @end itemize
9701
9702 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9703 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9704 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9705 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9706
9707 @itemize @bullet
9708 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9709 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9710 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9711 may not be as expected.
9712 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9713 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9714 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9715 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9716 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9717 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9718 @end itemize
9719
9720 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9721 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9722
9723 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9724 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9725 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9726 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9727
9728 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9729 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9730 @cindex SVF
9731
9732 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9733 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9734 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9735 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9736
9737 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9738 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9739 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9740 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9741
9742 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9743 affect their semantics.
9744
9745 Command options:
9746 @itemize @minus
9747 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9748 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9749 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9750 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9751 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9752 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9753 on the real interface;
9754 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9755 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9756 errors.
9757 @end itemize
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9761 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9762 @cindex XSVF
9763
9764 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9765 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9766 Xilinx devices.
9767 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9768 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9769
9770 @quotation Important
9771 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9772 @end quotation
9773
9774 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9775 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9776 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9777 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9778 that TAP.
9779 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9780 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9781 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9782 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9783 @end deffn
9784
9785 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9786 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9787 after building the software.
9788 You may find them useful:
9789
9790 @itemize
9791 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9792 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9793 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9794 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9795 @end itemize
9796
9797 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9798 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9799 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9800 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9801 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9802 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9803 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9804
9805
9806 @node Utility Commands
9807 @chapter Utility Commands
9808 @cindex Utility Commands
9809
9810 @section RAM testing
9811 @cindex RAM testing
9812
9813 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9814 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9815 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9816 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9817 hardware problems.
9818
9819 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9820 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9821 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9822 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9823
9824 Load the memory testing functions with
9825
9826 @example
9827 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9828 @end example
9829
9830 to get access to the following facilities:
9831
9832 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9833 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9834 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9835 @end deffn
9836
9837 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9838 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9839 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9840 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9841 @end deffn
9842
9843 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9844 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9845 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9846 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9847 @end deffn
9848
9849 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9850 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9851 @end deffn
9852
9853 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9854 @cindex Firmware recovery
9855
9856 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9857 devices recovery with JTAG.
9858
9859 For quickstart instructions run:
9860 @example
9861 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9862 @end example
9863
9864 @node TFTP
9865 @chapter TFTP
9866 @cindex TFTP
9867 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9868 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9869
9870 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9871 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9872 server (tftpd). For example,
9873
9874 @example
9875 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9876 @end example
9877
9878 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9879 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9880
9881 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9882 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9883 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9884 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9885
9886 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9887 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9888 @cindex GDB
9889 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9890 to debug remote targets.
9891 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9892
9893 @itemize
9894 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9895 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9896 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9897 as shown in this chapter.
9898 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9899 that also will probably need to be configured.
9900 @end itemize
9901
9902 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9903 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9904 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9905 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9906 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9907 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9908
9909 @section Connecting to GDB
9910 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9911 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9912 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9913 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9914 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9915
9916 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9917
9918 @enumerate
9919 @item
9920 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9921 @example
9922 target remote localhost:3333
9923 @end example
9924 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9925
9926 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9927 @example
9928 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9929 @end example
9930 @item
9931 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9932 @example
9933 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9934 @end example
9935 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9936 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9937 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9938 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9939 @end enumerate
9940
9941 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9942 GDB command line.
9943
9944 @section Sample GDB session startup
9945
9946 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9947 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9948 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9949 small ARM program.
9950 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9951 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9952
9953 @example
9954 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9955 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9956 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9957 ...
9958 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9959 ...
9960 (gdb) load
9961 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9962 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9963 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9964 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9965 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9966 (gdb) continue
9967 Continuing.
9968 ...
9969 @end example
9970
9971 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9972 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9973 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9974 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9975
9976 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9977
9978 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9979 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9980 packet size and the device's memory map.
9981 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9982 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9983 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9984
9985 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9986 You may need to set those up by hand.
9987 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9988 something like:
9989
9990 @example
9991 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9992 @end example
9993
9994 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9995
9996 @example
9997 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9998 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9999 @end example
10000
10001 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10002 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10003 do not have such restrictions.
10004
10005 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10006 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10007 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10008 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10009
10010 @section Programming using GDB
10011 @cindex Programming using GDB
10012 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10013
10014 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10015 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10016 @example
10017 gdb_memory_map disable
10018 @end example
10019 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10020 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10021 working area.
10022
10023 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10024 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10025 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10026 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10027
10028 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10029 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10030
10031 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10032 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10033 @example
10034 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10035 @end example
10036
10037 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10038 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10039
10040 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10041 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10042 will be used.
10043
10044 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10045 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10046 @example
10047 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10048 @end example
10049 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10050
10051 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10052 can be used.
10053
10054 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10055 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10056 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10057
10058 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10059 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10060 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10061
10062 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10063 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10064 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10065 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10066 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10067 without any intrusion of the target process.
10068
10069 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10070 Place following command after target configuration:
10071 @example
10072 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10073 @end example
10074
10075 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10076 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10077 @example
10078 gdb_memory_map disable
10079 @end example
10080
10081 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10082 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10083 @example
10084 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10085 @end example
10086
10087 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10088 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10089
10090 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10091 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10092 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10093 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10094
10095 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10096 previously shown varibles.
10097
10098 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10099 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10100 @cindex SMP
10101 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10102 @itemize @bullet
10103 @item j - smp status request
10104 @item J - smp set request
10105 @end itemize
10106
10107 OpenOCD implements :
10108 @itemize @bullet
10109 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10110 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10111 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10112 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10113 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10114 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10115 @end itemize
10116
10117 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10118 @itemize @bullet
10119 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10120 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10121 @example
10122 set $_core 1
10123 #Jc01 packet is sent
10124 print $_core
10125 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10126 @end example
10127
10128 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10129 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10130
10131 @example
10132 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10133 define toggle0
10134 maint packet Jc0
10135 continue
10136 main packet Jc-1
10137 end
10138 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10139 define toggle1
10140 maint packet Jc1
10141 continue
10142 main packet Jc-1
10143 end
10144 @end example
10145 @end itemize
10146
10147 @section RTOS Support
10148 @cindex RTOS Support
10149 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10150
10151 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10152 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10153
10154 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10155 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10156 GDB commands.
10157
10158 @* An example setup is below:
10159
10160 @example
10161 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10162 @end example
10163
10164 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10165
10166 Currently supported rtos's include:
10167 @itemize @bullet
10168 @item @option{eCos}
10169 @item @option{ThreadX}
10170 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10171 @item @option{linux}
10172 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10173 @item @option{embKernel}
10174 @item @option{mqx}
10175 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10176 @item @option{nuttx}
10177 @end itemize
10178
10179 @quotation Note
10180 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10181 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10182 @end quotation
10183
10184 @table @code
10185 @item eCos symbols
10186 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10187 @item ThreadX symbols
10188 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10189 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10190 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10191 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10192 @tex
10193 \begingroup
10194 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10195 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10196 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10197 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10198 \par
10199 \endgroup
10200 @end tex
10201 @item linux symbols
10202 init_task.
10203 @item ChibiOS symbols
10204 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10205 @item embKernel symbols
10206 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10207 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10208 @item mqx symbols
10209 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10210 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10211 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10212 @item nuttx symbols
10213 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10214 @end table
10215
10216 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10217 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10218
10219 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10220 along with the project:
10221
10222 @table @code
10223 @item FreeRTOS
10224 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10225 @item uC/OS-III
10226 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10227 @end table
10228
10229 @node Tcl Scripting API
10230 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10231 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10232 @cindex Tcl scripts
10233 @section API rules
10234
10235 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10236 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10237 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10238
10239 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10240 pair list and lists.
10241
10242 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10243 list.
10244
10245 @example
10246 > set foo(me) Duane
10247 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10248 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10249 > set foo(duck) Donald
10250 @end example
10251
10252 If one does this:
10253
10254 @example
10255 > set foo
10256 @end example
10257
10258 The result is:
10259
10260 @example
10261 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10262 @end example
10263
10264 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10265
10266 @verbatim
10267 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10268 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10269 }
10270 @end verbatim
10271
10272 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10273 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10274
10275 @section Internal low-level Commands
10276
10277 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10278 invoke directly.
10279
10280 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10281 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10282 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10283
10284 @itemize @bullet
10285 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10286
10287 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10288 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10289
10290 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10291 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10292
10293 Return information about the flash banks
10294
10295 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10296
10297 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10298 its execution. Example:
10299
10300 @example
10301 > capture "reset init"
10302 @end example
10303
10304 @end itemize
10305
10306 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10307 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10308 called "flash_banks".
10309
10310 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10311
10312 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10313 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10314 holds one of the following values:
10315
10316 @itemize @bullet
10317 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10318 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10319 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10320 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10321 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10322 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10323 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10324 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10325 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10326 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10327 @end itemize
10328
10329 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10330
10331 @quotation Note
10332 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10333 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10334 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10335 is jim, not real tcl).
10336 @end quotation
10337
10338 @section Tcl RPC server
10339 @cindex RPC
10340
10341 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10342 commands and receive the results.
10343
10344 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10345 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10346 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10347 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10348 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10349
10350 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10351 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10352 @command{capture} command.
10353
10354 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10355
10356 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10357 @cindex RPC Notifications
10358
10359 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10360 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10361
10362 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10363 in the following format.
10364
10365 @verbatim
10366 type target_event event [event-name]
10367 type target_state state [state-name]
10368 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10369 @end verbatim
10370
10371 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10372 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10373 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10374 Defaults to off.
10375
10376 @end deffn
10377
10378 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10379 @cindex RPC trace output
10380
10381 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10382 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10383
10384 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10385
10386 @verbatim
10387 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10388 @end verbatim
10389
10390 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10391 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10392 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10393 Defaults to off.
10394
10395 See an example application here:
10396 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10397
10398 @end deffn
10399
10400 @node FAQ
10401 @chapter FAQ
10402 @cindex faq
10403 @enumerate
10404 @anchor{faqrtck}
10405 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10406 @cindex RTCK
10407 @cindex adaptive clocking
10408 @*
10409
10410 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10411 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10412 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10413 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10414
10415 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10416 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10417 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10418 @enumerate
10419 @item
10420 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10421 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10422 @item
10423 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10424 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10425 @end enumerate
10426
10427 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10428 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10429 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10430 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10431 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10432 power).
10433
10434 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10435 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10436 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10437 ARM926 scenario).
10438 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10439 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10440 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10441
10442 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10443 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10444 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10445 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10446
10447 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10448
10449 In order to make use of this,
10450 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10451 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10452
10453 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10454 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10455 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10456 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10457 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10458
10459 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10460 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10461 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10462 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10463
10464 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10465 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10466 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10467 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10468 with a CPLD.
10469 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10470 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10471 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10472 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10473 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10474 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10475
10476 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10477
10478 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10479
10480 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10481 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10482 depending on the chips on your board.
10483 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10484 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10485 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10486
10487 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10488 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10489 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10490
10491 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10492 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10493 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10494 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10495
10496 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10497 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10498 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10499 this way.
10500
10501 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10502 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10503 clock rate.
10504 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10505 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10506 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10507
10508 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10509
10510 @example
10511 # Example: 1.234MHz
10512 adapter_khz 1234
10513 @end example
10514
10515
10516 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10517
10518 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10519 around Windows filenames.
10520
10521 @example
10522 > echo \a
10523
10524 > echo @{\a@}
10525 \a
10526 > echo "\a"
10527
10528 >
10529 @end example
10530
10531
10532 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10533
10534 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10535 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10536 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10537
10538 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10539 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10540 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10541
10542 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10543 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10544 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10545
10546 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10547
10548 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10549 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10550 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10551 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10552
10553 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10554 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10555 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10556
10557 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10558 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10559
10560 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10561 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10562 memory read caused data abort".
10563
10564 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10565 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10566 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10567 be done, feel free to add this here.
10568
10569 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10570 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10571 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10572 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10573 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10574 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10575 gracefully stops.
10576
10577 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10578 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10579 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10580
10581 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10582 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10583 bytes. Painful...
10584
10585
10586 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10587 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10588
10589 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10590 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10591 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10592 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10593 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10594 reset, everything else should work fine.
10595
10596 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10597 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10598 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10599 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10600
10601 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10602 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10603 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10604 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10605
10606 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10607
10608 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10609 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10610 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10611
10612 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10613 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10614
10615 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10616 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10617 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10618 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10619 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10620 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10621 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10622 clock frequency?
10623
10624 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10625 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10626 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10627 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10628 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10629
10630 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10631
10632 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10633 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10634 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10635 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10636 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10637 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10638 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10639
10640 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10641
10642 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10643 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10644 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10645 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10646
10647 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10648 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10649 particular order?
10650
10651 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10652 the same order used by the hardware.
10653
10654 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10655 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10656 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10657 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10658 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10659 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10660
10661 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10662 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10663 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10664 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10665
10666 @itemize @bullet
10667 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10668 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10669 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10670 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10671 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10672 @end itemize
10673
10674 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10675
10676 @itemize @bullet
10677 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10678 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10679 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10680 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10681 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10682 @end itemize
10683
10684
10685 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10686 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10687 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10688
10689 TODO.
10690
10691 @end enumerate
10692
10693 @node Tcl Crash Course
10694 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10695 @cindex Tcl
10696
10697 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10698 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10699 how the Tcl scripts work.
10700
10701 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10702 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10703 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10704 OpenOCD.
10705
10706 @section Tcl Rule #1
10707 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10708 @enumerate
10709 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10710 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10711 @end enumerate
10712
10713 The Tcl equal is this:
10714
10715 @enumerate
10716 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10717 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10718 @end enumerate
10719
10720 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10721 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10722
10723 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10724 There is a second pair of rules.
10725 @enumerate
10726 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10727 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10728 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10729 in Tcl.
10730 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10731 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10732 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10733 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10734 @end enumerate
10735
10736 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10737 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10738 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10739 Everything is a string}
10740
10741 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10742 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10743 difference is subtle.
10744 @enumerate
10745 @item Parse Time
10746 @item Evaluation Time
10747 @end enumerate
10748
10749 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10750 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10751 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10752
10753 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10754 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10755 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10756 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10757
10758 @itemize @bullet
10759 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10760 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10761 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10762 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10763 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10764 @example
10765 # bash example
10766 X=`date`
10767 echo "The Date is: $X"
10768 # Tcl example
10769 set X [date]
10770 puts "The Date is: $X"
10771 @end example
10772 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10773 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10774 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10775 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10776 is a string}
10777 @example
10778 set x "Dinner"
10779 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10780 @end example
10781 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10782 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10783 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10784 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10785 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10786 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10787 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10788 @end itemize
10789
10790 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10791
10792 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10793
10794 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10795
10796 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10797 the normal way.
10798
10799 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10800 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10801 line is immediately executed.
10802
10803 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10804 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10805
10806 @subsection Command Execution
10807
10808 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10809 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10810 control flow operators.
10811
10812 Commands are executed like this:
10813
10814 @enumerate
10815 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10816 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10817 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10818 @end enumerate
10819
10820 It sort of works like this:
10821 @example
10822 for(;;)@{
10823 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10824
10825 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10826
10827 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10828 @}
10829 @end example
10830
10831 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10832 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10833 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10834 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10835 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10836 ``LookupCommand()''
10837
10838 @subsection The FOR command
10839
10840 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10841 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10842 command just like any other command.
10843
10844 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10845 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10846 are:
10847
10848 @enumerate 0
10849 @item The ascii text 'for'
10850 @item The start text
10851 @item The test expression
10852 @item The next text
10853 @item The body text
10854 @end enumerate
10855
10856 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10857 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10858 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10859 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10860
10861 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10862 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10863
10864 @example
10865 int
10866 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10867 int *argc,
10868 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10869 @end example
10870
10871 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10872 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10873 still operates in the same basic way.
10874
10875 @subsection FOR command implementation
10876
10877 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10878 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10879
10880 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10881
10882 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10883
10884 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10885 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10886 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10887
10888 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10889 expression and returns a value.
10890
10891 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10892 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10893 @example
10894 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10895
10896 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10897
10898 int
10899 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10900 int argc,
10901 char **argv )
10902 @{
10903 if( argc != 5 )@{
10904 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10905 return ERROR;
10906 @}
10907
10908 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10909
10910 // Execute the start statement.
10911 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10912
10913 // Top of loop test
10914 for(;;)@{
10915 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10916 if( i == 0 )
10917 break;
10918
10919 // Execute the body
10920 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10921
10922 // Execute the LOOP part
10923 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10924 @}
10925
10926 // Return no error
10927 SetResult( interp, "" );
10928 return SUCCESS;
10929 @}
10930 @end example
10931
10932 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10933 in the same basic way.
10934
10935 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10936
10937 @subsection source and find commands
10938 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10939 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10940 @*Remember the parsing rules
10941 @enumerate
10942 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10943 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10944 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10945 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10946 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10947 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10948 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10949 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10950 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10951 @end enumerate
10952 @subsection format command
10953 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10954 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10955 @b{sprintf()}.
10956 @b{Example}
10957 @example
10958 set x 6
10959 set y 7
10960 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10961 @end example
10962 @enumerate
10963 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10964 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10965 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10966 @* Refer to Rule #1
10967 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10968 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10969 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10970 @end enumerate
10971 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10972 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10973 @example
10974 #1 Good
10975 proc someproc @{@} @{
10976 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10977 @}
10978 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10979 #2 Good - no variables
10980 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10981 #3 Good Curly Braces
10982 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10983 puts "Time: [date]"
10984 @}
10985 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10986 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10987 @end example
10988 @enumerate
10989 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10990 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10991 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10992 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10993 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10994 command.
10995 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10996 @*There are 4 examples:
10997 @enumerate
10998 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10999 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11000 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11001 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11002 @end enumerate
11003
11004 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11005 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11006 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11007
11008 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11009 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11010 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11011 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11012 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11013 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11014 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11015 @end enumerate
11016 @subsection Global Variables
11017 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11018 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11019 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11020 @example
11021 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11022 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11023 global x #Global variable X
11024 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11025 @}
11026 @end example
11027 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11028 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11029 @example
11030 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11031 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11032 # Create var name
11033 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11034 # Make it a global
11035 global $vn
11036 # Set it.
11037 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11038 @}
11039 @end example
11040 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11041 @example
11042 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11043 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11044 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11045 @}
11046 @end example
11047
11048 @include fdl.texi
11049
11050 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11051 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11052 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11053 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11054 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11055 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11056
11057 @printindex cp
11058
11059 @node Command and Driver Index
11060 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11061 @printindex fn
11062
11063 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)